xref: /linux/include/net/mac80211.h (revision e724e7aaf9ca794670a4d4931af7a7e24e37fec3)
1 /* SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-only */
2 /*
3  * mac80211 <-> driver interface
4  *
5  * Copyright 2002-2005, Devicescape Software, Inc.
6  * Copyright 2006-2007	Jiri Benc <jbenc@suse.cz>
7  * Copyright 2007-2010	Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net>
8  * Copyright 2013-2014  Intel Mobile Communications GmbH
9  * Copyright (C) 2015 - 2017 Intel Deutschland GmbH
10  * Copyright (C) 2018 - 2023 Intel Corporation
11  */
12 
13 #ifndef MAC80211_H
14 #define MAC80211_H
15 
16 #include <linux/bug.h>
17 #include <linux/kernel.h>
18 #include <linux/if_ether.h>
19 #include <linux/skbuff.h>
20 #include <linux/ieee80211.h>
21 #include <linux/lockdep.h>
22 #include <net/cfg80211.h>
23 #include <net/codel.h>
24 #include <net/ieee80211_radiotap.h>
25 #include <asm/unaligned.h>
26 
27 /**
28  * DOC: Introduction
29  *
30  * mac80211 is the Linux stack for 802.11 hardware that implements
31  * only partial functionality in hard- or firmware. This document
32  * defines the interface between mac80211 and low-level hardware
33  * drivers.
34  */
35 
36 /**
37  * DOC: Calling mac80211 from interrupts
38  *
39  * Only ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() can be
40  * called in hardware interrupt context. The low-level driver must not call any
41  * other functions in hardware interrupt context. If there is a need for such
42  * call, the low-level driver should first ACK the interrupt and perform the
43  * IEEE 802.11 code call after this, e.g. from a scheduled workqueue or even
44  * tasklet function.
45  *
46  * NOTE: If the driver opts to use the _irqsafe() functions, it may not also
47  *	 use the non-IRQ-safe functions!
48  */
49 
50 /**
51  * DOC: Warning
52  *
53  * If you're reading this document and not the header file itself, it will
54  * be incomplete because not all documentation has been converted yet.
55  */
56 
57 /**
58  * DOC: Frame format
59  *
60  * As a general rule, when frames are passed between mac80211 and the driver,
61  * they start with the IEEE 802.11 header and include the same octets that are
62  * sent over the air except for the FCS which should be calculated by the
63  * hardware.
64  *
65  * There are, however, various exceptions to this rule for advanced features:
66  *
67  * The first exception is for hardware encryption and decryption offload
68  * where the IV/ICV may or may not be generated in hardware.
69  *
70  * Secondly, when the hardware handles fragmentation, the frame handed to
71  * the driver from mac80211 is the MSDU, not the MPDU.
72  */
73 
74 /**
75  * DOC: mac80211 workqueue
76  *
77  * mac80211 provides its own workqueue for drivers and internal mac80211 use.
78  * The workqueue is a single threaded workqueue and can only be accessed by
79  * helpers for sanity checking. Drivers must ensure all work added onto the
80  * mac80211 workqueue should be cancelled on the driver stop() callback.
81  *
82  * mac80211 will flushed the workqueue upon interface removal and during
83  * suspend.
84  *
85  * All work performed on the mac80211 workqueue must not acquire the RTNL lock.
86  *
87  */
88 
89 /**
90  * DOC: mac80211 software tx queueing
91  *
92  * mac80211 uses an intermediate queueing implementation, designed to allow the
93  * driver to keep hardware queues short and to provide some fairness between
94  * different stations/interfaces.
95  *
96  * Drivers must provide the .wake_tx_queue driver operation by either
97  * linking it to ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue() or implementing a custom
98  * handler.
99  *
100  * Intermediate queues (struct ieee80211_txq) are kept per-sta per-tid, with
101  * another per-sta for non-data/non-mgmt and bufferable management frames, and
102  * a single per-vif queue for multicast data frames.
103  *
104  * The driver is expected to initialize its private per-queue data for stations
105  * and interfaces in the .add_interface and .sta_add ops.
106  *
107  * The driver can't access the internal TX queues (iTXQs) directly.
108  * Whenever mac80211 adds a new frame to a queue, it calls the .wake_tx_queue
109  * driver op.
110  * Drivers implementing a custom .wake_tx_queue op can get them by calling
111  * ieee80211_tx_dequeue(). Drivers using ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue() will
112  * simply get the individual frames pushed via the .tx driver operation.
113  *
114  * Drivers can optionally delegate responsibility for scheduling queues to
115  * mac80211, to take advantage of airtime fairness accounting. In this case, to
116  * obtain the next queue to pull frames from, the driver calls
117  * ieee80211_next_txq(). The driver is then expected to return the txq using
118  * ieee80211_return_txq().
119  *
120  * For AP powersave TIM handling, the driver only needs to indicate if it has
121  * buffered packets in the driver specific data structures by calling
122  * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(). For frames buffered in the ieee80211_txq
123  * struct, mac80211 sets the appropriate TIM PVB bits and calls
124  * .release_buffered_frames().
125  * In that callback the driver is therefore expected to release its own
126  * buffered frames and afterwards also frames from the ieee80211_txq (obtained
127  * via the usual ieee80211_tx_dequeue).
128  */
129 
130 /**
131  * DOC: HW timestamping
132  *
133  * Timing Measurement and Fine Timing Measurement require accurate timestamps
134  * of the action frames TX/RX and their respective acks.
135  *
136  * To report hardware timestamps for Timing Measurement or Fine Timing
137  * Measurement frame RX, the low level driver should set the SKB's hwtstamp
138  * field to the frame RX timestamp and report the ack TX timestamp in the
139  * ieee80211_rx_status struct.
140  *
141  * Similarly, To report hardware timestamps for Timing Measurement or Fine
142  * Timing Measurement frame TX, the driver should set the SKB's hwtstamp field
143  * to the frame TX timestamp and report the ack RX timestamp in the
144  * ieee80211_tx_status struct.
145  */
146 struct device;
147 
148 /**
149  * enum ieee80211_max_queues - maximum number of queues
150  *
151  * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES: Maximum number of regular device queues.
152  * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP: bitmap with maximum queues set
153  */
154 enum ieee80211_max_queues {
155 	IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES =		16,
156 	IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP =	BIT(IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES) - 1,
157 };
158 
159 #define IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE	0xff
160 
161 /**
162  * enum ieee80211_ac_numbers - AC numbers as used in mac80211
163  * @IEEE80211_AC_VO: voice
164  * @IEEE80211_AC_VI: video
165  * @IEEE80211_AC_BE: best effort
166  * @IEEE80211_AC_BK: background
167  */
168 enum ieee80211_ac_numbers {
169 	IEEE80211_AC_VO		= 0,
170 	IEEE80211_AC_VI		= 1,
171 	IEEE80211_AC_BE		= 2,
172 	IEEE80211_AC_BK		= 3,
173 };
174 
175 /**
176  * struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params - transmit queue configuration
177  *
178  * The information provided in this structure is required for QoS
179  * transmit queue configuration. Cf. IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.29.
180  *
181  * @aifs: arbitration interframe space [0..255]
182  * @cw_min: minimum contention window [a value of the form
183  *	2^n-1 in the range 1..32767]
184  * @cw_max: maximum contention window [like @cw_min]
185  * @txop: maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning disabled
186  * @acm: is mandatory admission control required for the access category
187  * @uapsd: is U-APSD mode enabled for the queue
188  * @mu_edca: is the MU EDCA configured
189  * @mu_edca_param_rec: MU EDCA Parameter Record for HE
190  */
191 struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params {
192 	u16 txop;
193 	u16 cw_min;
194 	u16 cw_max;
195 	u8 aifs;
196 	bool acm;
197 	bool uapsd;
198 	bool mu_edca;
199 	struct ieee80211_he_mu_edca_param_ac_rec mu_edca_param_rec;
200 };
201 
202 struct ieee80211_low_level_stats {
203 	unsigned int dot11ACKFailureCount;
204 	unsigned int dot11RTSFailureCount;
205 	unsigned int dot11FCSErrorCount;
206 	unsigned int dot11RTSSuccessCount;
207 };
208 
209 /**
210  * enum ieee80211_chanctx_change - change flag for channel context
211  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH: The channel width changed
212  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS: The number of RX chains changed
213  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR: radar detection flag changed
214  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL: switched to another operating channel,
215  *	this is used only with channel switching with CSA
216  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_WIDTH: The min required channel width changed
217  */
218 enum ieee80211_chanctx_change {
219 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH		= BIT(0),
220 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS	= BIT(1),
221 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR		= BIT(2),
222 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL	= BIT(3),
223 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_WIDTH	= BIT(4),
224 };
225 
226 /**
227  * struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf - channel context that vifs may be tuned to
228  *
229  * This is the driver-visible part. The ieee80211_chanctx
230  * that contains it is visible in mac80211 only.
231  *
232  * @def: the channel definition
233  * @min_def: the minimum channel definition currently required.
234  * @rx_chains_static: The number of RX chains that must always be
235  *	active on the channel to receive MIMO transmissions
236  * @rx_chains_dynamic: The number of RX chains that must be enabled
237  *	after RTS/CTS handshake to receive SMPS MIMO transmissions;
238  *	this will always be >= @rx_chains_static.
239  * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled on this channel.
240  * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
241  *	sizeof(void *), size is determined in hw information.
242  */
243 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf {
244 	struct cfg80211_chan_def def;
245 	struct cfg80211_chan_def min_def;
246 
247 	u8 rx_chains_static, rx_chains_dynamic;
248 
249 	bool radar_enabled;
250 
251 	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
252 };
253 
254 /**
255  * enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode - channel context switch mode
256  * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF: Both old and new contexts already
257  *	exist (and will continue to exist), but the virtual interface
258  *	needs to be switched from one to the other.
259  * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS: The old context exists but will stop
260  *      to exist with this call, the new context doesn't exist but
261  *      will be active after this call, the virtual interface switches
262  *      from the old to the new (note that the driver may of course
263  *      implement this as an on-the-fly chandef switch of the existing
264  *      hardware context, but the mac80211 pointer for the old context
265  *      will cease to exist and only the new one will later be used
266  *      for changes/removal.)
267  */
268 enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode {
269 	CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF,
270 	CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS,
271 };
272 
273 /**
274  * struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch - vif chanctx switch information
275  *
276  * This is structure is used to pass information about a vif that
277  * needs to switch from one chanctx to another.  The
278  * &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode defines how the switch should be
279  * done.
280  *
281  * @vif: the vif that should be switched from old_ctx to new_ctx
282  * @link_conf: the link conf that's switching
283  * @old_ctx: the old context to which the vif was assigned
284  * @new_ctx: the new context to which the vif must be assigned
285  */
286 struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch {
287 	struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
288 	struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf;
289 	struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *old_ctx;
290 	struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *new_ctx;
291 };
292 
293 /**
294  * enum ieee80211_bss_change - BSS change notification flags
295  *
296  * These flags are used with the bss_info_changed(), link_info_changed()
297  * and vif_cfg_changed() callbacks to indicate which parameter(s) changed.
298  *
299  * @BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC: association status changed (associated/disassociated),
300  *	also implies a change in the AID.
301  * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT: CTS protection changed
302  * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE: preamble changed
303  * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT: slot timing changed
304  * @BSS_CHANGED_HT: 802.11n parameters changed
305  * @BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES: Basic rateset changed
306  * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT: Beacon interval changed
307  * @BSS_CHANGED_BSSID: BSSID changed, for whatever
308  *	reason (IBSS and managed mode)
309  * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON: Beacon data changed, retrieve
310  *	new beacon (beaconing modes)
311  * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED: Beaconing should be
312  *	enabled/disabled (beaconing modes)
313  * @BSS_CHANGED_CQM: Connection quality monitor config changed
314  * @BSS_CHANGED_IBSS: IBSS join status changed
315  * @BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER: Hardware ARP filter address list or state changed.
316  * @BSS_CHANGED_QOS: QoS for this association was enabled/disabled. Note
317  *	that it is only ever disabled for station mode.
318  * @BSS_CHANGED_IDLE: Idle changed for this BSS/interface.
319  * @BSS_CHANGED_SSID: SSID changed for this BSS (AP and IBSS mode)
320  * @BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP: Probe Response changed for this BSS (AP mode)
321  * @BSS_CHANGED_PS: PS changed for this BSS (STA mode)
322  * @BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER: TX power setting changed for this interface
323  * @BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS: P2P powersave settings (CTWindow, opportunistic PS)
324  *	changed
325  * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO: Data from the AP's beacon became available:
326  *	currently dtim_period only is under consideration.
327  * @BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH: The bandwidth used by this interface changed,
328  *	note that this is only called when it changes after the channel
329  *	context had been assigned.
330  * @BSS_CHANGED_OCB: OCB join status changed
331  * @BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS: VHT MU-MIMO group id or user position changed
332  * @BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE: keep alive options (idle period or protected
333  *	keep alive) changed.
334  * @BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE: Multicast Rate setting changed for this interface
335  * @BSS_CHANGED_FTM_RESPONDER: fine timing measurement request responder
336  *	functionality changed for this BSS (AP mode).
337  * @BSS_CHANGED_TWT: TWT status changed
338  * @BSS_CHANGED_HE_OBSS_PD: OBSS Packet Detection status changed.
339  * @BSS_CHANGED_HE_BSS_COLOR: BSS Color has changed
340  * @BSS_CHANGED_FILS_DISCOVERY: FILS discovery status changed.
341  * @BSS_CHANGED_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Unsolicited broadcast probe response
342  *	status changed.
343  * @BSS_CHANGED_EHT_PUNCTURING: The channel puncturing bitmap changed.
344  */
345 enum ieee80211_bss_change {
346 	BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC		= 1<<0,
347 	BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT	= 1<<1,
348 	BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE	= 1<<2,
349 	BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT		= 1<<3,
350 	BSS_CHANGED_HT			= 1<<4,
351 	BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES		= 1<<5,
352 	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT		= 1<<6,
353 	BSS_CHANGED_BSSID		= 1<<7,
354 	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON		= 1<<8,
355 	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED	= 1<<9,
356 	BSS_CHANGED_CQM			= 1<<10,
357 	BSS_CHANGED_IBSS		= 1<<11,
358 	BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER		= 1<<12,
359 	BSS_CHANGED_QOS			= 1<<13,
360 	BSS_CHANGED_IDLE		= 1<<14,
361 	BSS_CHANGED_SSID		= 1<<15,
362 	BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP	= 1<<16,
363 	BSS_CHANGED_PS			= 1<<17,
364 	BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER		= 1<<18,
365 	BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS		= 1<<19,
366 	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO		= 1<<20,
367 	BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH		= 1<<21,
368 	BSS_CHANGED_OCB                 = 1<<22,
369 	BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS		= 1<<23,
370 	BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE		= 1<<24,
371 	BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE		= 1<<25,
372 	BSS_CHANGED_FTM_RESPONDER	= 1<<26,
373 	BSS_CHANGED_TWT			= 1<<27,
374 	BSS_CHANGED_HE_OBSS_PD		= 1<<28,
375 	BSS_CHANGED_HE_BSS_COLOR	= 1<<29,
376 	BSS_CHANGED_FILS_DISCOVERY      = 1<<30,
377 	BSS_CHANGED_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP = 1<<31,
378 	BSS_CHANGED_EHT_PUNCTURING	= BIT_ULL(32),
379 
380 	/* when adding here, make sure to change ieee80211_reconfig */
381 };
382 
383 /*
384  * The maximum number of IPv4 addresses listed for ARP filtering. If the number
385  * of addresses for an interface increase beyond this value, hardware ARP
386  * filtering will be disabled.
387  */
388 #define IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN 4
389 
390 /**
391  * enum ieee80211_event_type - event to be notified to the low level driver
392  * @RSSI_EVENT: AP's rssi crossed the a threshold set by the driver.
393  * @MLME_EVENT: event related to MLME
394  * @BAR_RX_EVENT: a BAR was received
395  * @BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT: Frames were released from the reordering buffer because
396  *	they timed out. This won't be called for each frame released, but only
397  *	once each time the timeout triggers.
398  */
399 enum ieee80211_event_type {
400 	RSSI_EVENT,
401 	MLME_EVENT,
402 	BAR_RX_EVENT,
403 	BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT,
404 };
405 
406 /**
407  * enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data - relevant when event type is %RSSI_EVENT
408  * @RSSI_EVENT_HIGH: AP's rssi went below the threshold set by the driver.
409  * @RSSI_EVENT_LOW: AP's rssi went above the threshold set by the driver.
410  */
411 enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data {
412 	RSSI_EVENT_HIGH,
413 	RSSI_EVENT_LOW,
414 };
415 
416 /**
417  * struct ieee80211_rssi_event - data attached to an %RSSI_EVENT
418  * @data: See &enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data
419  */
420 struct ieee80211_rssi_event {
421 	enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data data;
422 };
423 
424 /**
425  * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT
426  * @AUTH_EVENT: the MLME operation is authentication
427  * @ASSOC_EVENT: the MLME operation is association
428  * @DEAUTH_RX_EVENT: deauth received..
429  * @DEAUTH_TX_EVENT: deauth sent.
430  */
431 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data {
432 	AUTH_EVENT,
433 	ASSOC_EVENT,
434 	DEAUTH_RX_EVENT,
435 	DEAUTH_TX_EVENT,
436 };
437 
438 /**
439  * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT
440  * @MLME_SUCCESS: the MLME operation completed successfully.
441  * @MLME_DENIED: the MLME operation was denied by the peer.
442  * @MLME_TIMEOUT: the MLME operation timed out.
443  */
444 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status {
445 	MLME_SUCCESS,
446 	MLME_DENIED,
447 	MLME_TIMEOUT,
448 };
449 
450 /**
451  * struct ieee80211_mlme_event - data attached to an %MLME_EVENT
452  * @data: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data
453  * @status: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status
454  * @reason: the reason code if applicable
455  */
456 struct ieee80211_mlme_event {
457 	enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data data;
458 	enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status status;
459 	u16 reason;
460 };
461 
462 /**
463  * struct ieee80211_ba_event - data attached for BlockAck related events
464  * @sta: pointer to the &ieee80211_sta to which this event relates
465  * @tid: the tid
466  * @ssn: the starting sequence number (for %BAR_RX_EVENT)
467  */
468 struct ieee80211_ba_event {
469 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
470 	u16 tid;
471 	u16 ssn;
472 };
473 
474 /**
475  * struct ieee80211_event - event to be sent to the driver
476  * @type: The event itself. See &enum ieee80211_event_type.
477  * @rssi: relevant if &type is %RSSI_EVENT
478  * @mlme: relevant if &type is %AUTH_EVENT
479  * @ba: relevant if &type is %BAR_RX_EVENT or %BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT
480  * @u:union holding the fields above
481  */
482 struct ieee80211_event {
483 	enum ieee80211_event_type type;
484 	union {
485 		struct ieee80211_rssi_event rssi;
486 		struct ieee80211_mlme_event mlme;
487 		struct ieee80211_ba_event ba;
488 	} u;
489 };
490 
491 /**
492  * struct ieee80211_mu_group_data - STA's VHT MU-MIMO group data
493  *
494  * This structure describes the group id data of VHT MU-MIMO
495  *
496  * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group
497  * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group
498  */
499 struct ieee80211_mu_group_data {
500 	u8 membership[WLAN_MEMBERSHIP_LEN];
501 	u8 position[WLAN_USER_POSITION_LEN];
502 };
503 
504 /**
505  * struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params - FTM responder parameters
506  *
507  * @lci: LCI subelement content
508  * @civicloc: CIVIC location subelement content
509  * @lci_len: LCI data length
510  * @civicloc_len: Civic data length
511  */
512 struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params {
513 	const u8 *lci;
514 	const u8 *civicloc;
515 	size_t lci_len;
516 	size_t civicloc_len;
517 };
518 
519 /**
520  * struct ieee80211_fils_discovery - FILS discovery parameters from
521  * IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail.
522  *
523  * @min_interval: Minimum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
524  * @max_interval: Maximum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
525  */
526 struct ieee80211_fils_discovery {
527 	u32 min_interval;
528 	u32 max_interval;
529 };
530 
531 /**
532  * struct ieee80211_bss_conf - holds the BSS's changing parameters
533  *
534  * This structure keeps information about a BSS (and an association
535  * to that BSS) that can change during the lifetime of the BSS.
536  *
537  * @vif: reference to owning VIF
538  * @addr: (link) address used locally
539  * @link_id: link ID, or 0 for non-MLO
540  * @htc_trig_based_pkt_ext: default PE in 4us units, if BSS supports HE
541  * @uora_exists: is the UORA element advertised by AP
542  * @ack_enabled: indicates support to receive a multi-TID that solicits either
543  *	ACK, BACK or both
544  * @uora_ocw_range: UORA element's OCW Range field
545  * @frame_time_rts_th: HE duration RTS threshold, in units of 32us
546  * @he_support: does this BSS support HE
547  * @twt_requester: does this BSS support TWT requester (relevant for managed
548  *	mode only, set if the AP advertises TWT responder role)
549  * @twt_responder: does this BSS support TWT requester (relevant for managed
550  *	mode only, set if the AP advertises TWT responder role)
551  * @twt_protected: does this BSS support protected TWT frames
552  * @twt_broadcast: does this BSS support broadcast TWT
553  * @use_cts_prot: use CTS protection
554  * @use_short_preamble: use 802.11b short preamble
555  * @use_short_slot: use short slot time (only relevant for ERP)
556  * @dtim_period: num of beacons before the next DTIM, for beaconing,
557  *	valid in station mode only if after the driver was notified
558  *	with the %BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO flag, will be non-zero then.
559  * @sync_tsf: last beacon's/probe response's TSF timestamp (could be old
560  *	as it may have been received during scanning long ago). If the
561  *	HW flag %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY is set, then this can
562  *	only come from a beacon, but might not become valid until after
563  *	association when a beacon is received (which is notified with the
564  *	%BSS_CHANGED_DTIM flag.). See also sync_dtim_count important notice.
565  * @sync_device_ts: the device timestamp corresponding to the sync_tsf,
566  *	the driver/device can use this to calculate synchronisation
567  *	(see @sync_tsf). See also sync_dtim_count important notice.
568  * @sync_dtim_count: Only valid when %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY
569  *	is requested, see @sync_tsf/@sync_device_ts.
570  *	IMPORTANT: These three sync_* parameters would possibly be out of sync
571  *	by the time the driver will use them. The synchronized view is currently
572  *	guaranteed only in certain callbacks.
573  *	Note also that this is not used with MLD associations, mac80211 doesn't
574  *	know how to track beacons for all of the links for this.
575  * @beacon_int: beacon interval
576  * @assoc_capability: capabilities taken from assoc resp
577  * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates, each bit stands for an
578  *	index into the rate table configured by the driver in
579  *	the current band.
580  * @beacon_rate: associated AP's beacon TX rate
581  * @mcast_rate: per-band multicast rate index + 1 (0: disabled)
582  * @bssid: The BSSID for this BSS
583  * @enable_beacon: whether beaconing should be enabled or not
584  * @chandef: Channel definition for this BSS -- the hardware might be
585  *	configured a higher bandwidth than this BSS uses, for example.
586  * @mu_group: VHT MU-MIMO group membership data
587  * @ht_operation_mode: HT operation mode like in &struct ieee80211_ht_operation.
588  *	This field is only valid when the channel is a wide HT/VHT channel.
589  *	Note that with TDLS this can be the case (channel is HT, protection must
590  *	be used from this field) even when the BSS association isn't using HT.
591  * @cqm_rssi_thold: Connection quality monitor RSSI threshold, a zero value
592  *	implies disabled. As with the cfg80211 callback, a change here should
593  *	cause an event to be sent indicating where the current value is in
594  *	relation to the newly configured threshold.
595  * @cqm_rssi_low: Connection quality monitor RSSI lower threshold, a zero value
596  *	implies disabled.  This is an alternative mechanism to the single
597  *	threshold event and can't be enabled simultaneously with it.
598  * @cqm_rssi_high: Connection quality monitor RSSI upper threshold.
599  * @cqm_rssi_hyst: Connection quality monitor RSSI hysteresis
600  * @qos: This is a QoS-enabled BSS.
601  * @hidden_ssid: The SSID of the current vif is hidden. Only valid in AP-mode.
602  * @txpower: TX power in dBm.  INT_MIN means not configured.
603  * @txpower_type: TX power adjustment used to control per packet Transmit
604  *	Power Control (TPC) in lower driver for the current vif. In particular
605  *	TPC is enabled if value passed in %txpower_type is
606  *	NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED (allow using less than specified from
607  *	userspace), whereas TPC is disabled if %txpower_type is set to
608  *	NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED (use value configured from userspace)
609  * @p2p_noa_attr: P2P NoA attribute for P2P powersave
610  * @allow_p2p_go_ps: indication for AP or P2P GO interface, whether it's allowed
611  *	to use P2P PS mechanism or not. AP/P2P GO is not allowed to use P2P PS
612  *	if it has associated clients without P2P PS support.
613  * @max_idle_period: the time period during which the station can refrain from
614  *	transmitting frames to its associated AP without being disassociated.
615  *	In units of 1000 TUs. Zero value indicates that the AP did not include
616  *	a (valid) BSS Max Idle Period Element.
617  * @protected_keep_alive: if set, indicates that the station should send an RSN
618  *	protected frame to the AP to reset the idle timer at the AP for the
619  *	station.
620  * @ftm_responder: whether to enable or disable fine timing measurement FTM
621  *	responder functionality.
622  * @ftmr_params: configurable lci/civic parameter when enabling FTM responder.
623  * @nontransmitted: this BSS is a nontransmitted BSS profile
624  * @transmitter_bssid: the address of transmitter AP
625  * @bssid_index: index inside the multiple BSSID set
626  * @bssid_indicator: 2^bssid_indicator is the maximum number of APs in set
627  * @ema_ap: AP supports enhancements of discovery and advertisement of
628  *	nontransmitted BSSIDs
629  * @profile_periodicity: the least number of beacon frames need to be received
630  *	in order to discover all the nontransmitted BSSIDs in the set.
631  * @he_oper: HE operation information of the BSS (AP/Mesh) or of the AP we are
632  *	connected to (STA)
633  * @he_obss_pd: OBSS Packet Detection parameters.
634  * @he_bss_color: BSS coloring settings, if BSS supports HE
635  * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery configuration
636  * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp_interval: Unsolicited broadcast probe response
637  *	interval.
638  * @beacon_tx_rate: The configured beacon transmit rate that needs to be passed
639  *	to driver when rate control is offloaded to firmware.
640  * @power_type: power type of BSS for 6 GHz
641  * @tx_pwr_env: transmit power envelope array of BSS.
642  * @tx_pwr_env_num: number of @tx_pwr_env.
643  * @pwr_reduction: power constraint of BSS.
644  * @eht_support: does this BSS support EHT
645  * @eht_puncturing: bitmap to indicate which channels are punctured in this BSS
646  * @csa_active: marks whether a channel switch is going on. Internally it is
647  *	write-protected by sdata_lock and local->mtx so holding either is fine
648  *	for read access.
649  * @csa_punct_bitmap: new puncturing bitmap for channel switch
650  * @mu_mimo_owner: indicates interface owns MU-MIMO capability
651  * @chanctx_conf: The channel context this interface is assigned to, or %NULL
652  *	when it is not assigned. This pointer is RCU-protected due to the TX
653  *	path needing to access it; even though the netdev carrier will always
654  *	be off when it is %NULL there can still be races and packets could be
655  *	processed after it switches back to %NULL.
656  * @color_change_active: marks whether a color change is ongoing. Internally it is
657  *	write-protected by sdata_lock and local->mtx so holding either is fine
658  *	for read access.
659  * @color_change_color: the bss color that will be used after the change.
660  * @ht_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has HT LDPC capability.
661  * @vht_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has VHT LDPC capability.
662  * @he_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has HE LDPC capability.
663  * @vht_su_beamformer: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT SU
664  *	beamformer
665  * @vht_su_beamformee: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT SU
666  *	beamformee
667  * @vht_mu_beamformer: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT MU
668  *	beamformer
669  * @vht_mu_beamformee: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT MU
670  *	beamformee
671  * @he_su_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE SU
672  *	beamformer
673  * @he_su_beamformee: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE SU
674  *	beamformee
675  * @he_mu_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE MU
676  *	beamformer
677  * @he_full_ul_mumimo: does this BSS support the reception (AP) or transmission
678  *	(non-AP STA) of an HE TB PPDU on an RU that spans the entire PPDU
679  *	bandwidth
680  * @eht_su_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT SU
681  *	beamformer
682  * @eht_su_beamformee: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT SU
683  *	beamformee
684  * @eht_mu_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT MU
685  *	beamformer
686  */
687 struct ieee80211_bss_conf {
688 	struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
689 
690 	const u8 *bssid;
691 	unsigned int link_id;
692 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
693 	u8 htc_trig_based_pkt_ext;
694 	bool uora_exists;
695 	u8 uora_ocw_range;
696 	u16 frame_time_rts_th;
697 	bool he_support;
698 	bool twt_requester;
699 	bool twt_responder;
700 	bool twt_protected;
701 	bool twt_broadcast;
702 	/* erp related data */
703 	bool use_cts_prot;
704 	bool use_short_preamble;
705 	bool use_short_slot;
706 	bool enable_beacon;
707 	u8 dtim_period;
708 	u16 beacon_int;
709 	u16 assoc_capability;
710 	u64 sync_tsf;
711 	u32 sync_device_ts;
712 	u8 sync_dtim_count;
713 	u32 basic_rates;
714 	struct ieee80211_rate *beacon_rate;
715 	int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
716 	u16 ht_operation_mode;
717 	s32 cqm_rssi_thold;
718 	u32 cqm_rssi_hyst;
719 	s32 cqm_rssi_low;
720 	s32 cqm_rssi_high;
721 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
722 	struct ieee80211_mu_group_data mu_group;
723 	bool qos;
724 	bool hidden_ssid;
725 	int txpower;
726 	enum nl80211_tx_power_setting txpower_type;
727 	struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr p2p_noa_attr;
728 	bool allow_p2p_go_ps;
729 	u16 max_idle_period;
730 	bool protected_keep_alive;
731 	bool ftm_responder;
732 	struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params *ftmr_params;
733 	/* Multiple BSSID data */
734 	bool nontransmitted;
735 	u8 transmitter_bssid[ETH_ALEN];
736 	u8 bssid_index;
737 	u8 bssid_indicator;
738 	bool ema_ap;
739 	u8 profile_periodicity;
740 	struct {
741 		u32 params;
742 		u16 nss_set;
743 	} he_oper;
744 	struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd he_obss_pd;
745 	struct cfg80211_he_bss_color he_bss_color;
746 	struct ieee80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery;
747 	u32 unsol_bcast_probe_resp_interval;
748 	struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_tx_rate;
749 	enum ieee80211_ap_reg_power power_type;
750 	struct ieee80211_tx_pwr_env tx_pwr_env[IEEE80211_TPE_MAX_IE_COUNT];
751 	u8 tx_pwr_env_num;
752 	u8 pwr_reduction;
753 	bool eht_support;
754 	u16 eht_puncturing;
755 
756 	bool csa_active;
757 	u16 csa_punct_bitmap;
758 
759 	bool mu_mimo_owner;
760 	struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf __rcu *chanctx_conf;
761 
762 	bool color_change_active;
763 	u8 color_change_color;
764 
765 	bool ht_ldpc;
766 	bool vht_ldpc;
767 	bool he_ldpc;
768 	bool vht_su_beamformer;
769 	bool vht_su_beamformee;
770 	bool vht_mu_beamformer;
771 	bool vht_mu_beamformee;
772 	bool he_su_beamformer;
773 	bool he_su_beamformee;
774 	bool he_mu_beamformer;
775 	bool he_full_ul_mumimo;
776 	bool eht_su_beamformer;
777 	bool eht_su_beamformee;
778 	bool eht_mu_beamformer;
779 };
780 
781 /**
782  * enum mac80211_tx_info_flags - flags to describe transmission information/status
783  *
784  * These flags are used with the @flags member of &ieee80211_tx_info.
785  *
786  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS: require TX status callback for this frame.
787  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ: The driver has to assign a sequence
788  *	number to this frame, taking care of not overwriting the fragment
789  *	number and increasing the sequence number only when the
790  *	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT flag is set. mac80211 will properly
791  *	assign sequence numbers to QoS-data frames but cannot do so correctly
792  *	for non-QoS-data and management frames because beacons need them from
793  *	that counter as well and mac80211 cannot guarantee proper sequencing.
794  *	If this flag is set, the driver should instruct the hardware to
795  *	assign a sequence number to the frame or assign one itself. Cf. IEEE
796  *	802.11-2007 7.1.3.4.1 paragraph 3. This flag will always be set for
797  *	beacons and always be clear for frames without a sequence number field.
798  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK: tell the low level not to wait for an ack
799  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT: clear powersave filter for destination
800  *	station
801  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT: this is a first fragment of the frame
802  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM: send this frame after DTIM beacon
803  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU: this frame should be sent as part of an A-MPDU
804  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED: Frame was injected, internal to mac80211.
805  * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED: The frame was not transmitted
806  *	because the destination STA was in powersave mode. Note that to
807  *	avoid race conditions, the filter must be set by the hardware or
808  *	firmware upon receiving a frame that indicates that the station
809  *	went to sleep (must be done on device to filter frames already on
810  *	the queue) and may only be unset after mac80211 gives the OK for
811  *	that by setting the IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT (see above),
812  *	since only then is it guaranteed that no more frames are in the
813  *	hardware queue.
814  * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK: Frame was acknowledged
815  * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU: The frame was aggregated, so status
816  * 	is for the whole aggregation.
817  * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK: no block ack was returned,
818  * 	so consider using block ack request (BAR).
819  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE: internal to mac80211, can be
820  *	set by rate control algorithms to indicate probe rate, will
821  *	be cleared for fragmented frames (except on the last fragment)
822  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK: Internal to mac80211. Used to indicate
823  *	that a frame can be transmitted while the queues are stopped for
824  *	off-channel operation.
825  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP: This frame uses hardware encapsulation
826  *	(header conversion)
827  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED: completely internal to mac80211,
828  *	used to indicate that a frame was already retried due to PS
829  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT: completely internal to mac80211,
830  *	used to indicate frame should not be encrypted
831  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER: This frame is a response to a poll
832  *	frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD) or a non-bufferable MMPDU and must
833  *	be sent although the station is in powersave mode.
834  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES: More frames will be passed to the
835  *	transmit function after the current frame, this can be used
836  *	by drivers to kick the DMA queue only if unset or when the
837  *	queue gets full.
838  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION: This frame is being retransmitted
839  *	after TX status because the destination was asleep, it must not
840  *	be modified again (no seqno assignment, crypto, etc.)
841  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX: This frame was transmitted by the MLME
842  *	code for connection establishment, this indicates that its status
843  *	should kick the MLME state machine.
844  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX: Frame was requested through nl80211
845  *	MLME command (internal to mac80211 to figure out whether to send TX
846  *	status to user space)
847  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC: tells the driver to use LDPC for this frame
848  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC: Enables Space-Time Block Coding (STBC) for this
849  *	frame and selects the maximum number of streams that it can use.
850  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN: Marks this packet to be transmitted on
851  *	the off-channel channel when a remain-on-channel offload is done
852  *	in hardware -- normal packets still flow and are expected to be
853  *	handled properly by the device.
854  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE: Marks this packet to be used for TKIP
855  *	testing. It will be sent out with incorrect Michael MIC key to allow
856  *	TKIP countermeasures to be tested.
857  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE: This frame will be sent at non CCK rate.
858  *	This flag is actually used for management frame especially for P2P
859  *	frames not being sent at CCK rate in 2GHz band.
860  * @IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP: This packet marks the end of service period,
861  *	when its status is reported the service period ends. For frames in
862  *	an SP that mac80211 transmits, it is already set; for driver frames
863  *	the driver may set this flag. It is also used to do the same for
864  *	PS-Poll responses.
865  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE: This frame will be sent at lowest rate.
866  *	This flag is used to send nullfunc frame at minimum rate when
867  *	the nullfunc is used for connection monitoring purpose.
868  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG: Don't fragment this packet even if it
869  *	would be fragmented by size (this is optional, only used for
870  *	monitor injection).
871  * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED: A frame that was marked with
872  *	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK has been successfully transmitted without
873  *	any errors (like issues specific to the driver/HW).
874  *	This flag must not be set for frames that don't request no-ack
875  *	behaviour with IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK.
876  *
877  * Note: If you have to add new flags to the enumeration, then don't
878  *	 forget to update %IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS when necessary.
879  */
880 enum mac80211_tx_info_flags {
881 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS		= BIT(0),
882 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ		= BIT(1),
883 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK			= BIT(2),
884 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT		= BIT(3),
885 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT		= BIT(4),
886 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM	= BIT(5),
887 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU			= BIT(6),
888 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED		= BIT(7),
889 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED		= BIT(8),
890 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK			= BIT(9),
891 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU			= BIT(10),
892 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK		= BIT(11),
893 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE	= BIT(12),
894 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK	= BIT(13),
895 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP		= BIT(14),
896 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED		= BIT(15),
897 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT		= BIT(16),
898 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER		= BIT(17),
899 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES		= BIT(18),
900 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION	= BIT(19),
901 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX		= BIT(20),
902 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX	= BIT(21),
903 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC			= BIT(22),
904 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC			= BIT(23) | BIT(24),
905 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN		= BIT(25),
906 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE	= BIT(26),
907 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE		= BIT(27),
908 	IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP		= BIT(28),
909 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE		= BIT(29),
910 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG		= BIT(30),
911 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED	= BIT(31),
912 };
913 
914 #define IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC_SHIFT		23
915 
916 #define IEEE80211_TX_RC_S1G_MCS IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS
917 
918 /**
919  * enum mac80211_tx_control_flags - flags to describe transmit control
920  *
921  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO: this frame is a port control
922  *	protocol frame (e.g. EAP)
923  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE: This frame is a response to a poll
924  *	frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD).
925  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT: This frame is injected with rate information
926  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU: This frame is an A-MSDU frame
927  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT: This frame is going through the fast_xmit path
928  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SKIP_MPATH_LOOKUP: This frame skips mesh path lookup
929  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTCFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING: completely internal to mac80211,
930  *	used to indicate that a pending frame requires TX processing before
931  *	it can be sent out.
932  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_NO_SEQNO: Do not overwrite the sequence number that
933  *	has already been assigned to this frame.
934  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_REORDER: This frame should not be reordered
935  *	relative to other frames that have this flag set, independent
936  *	of their QoS TID or other priority field values.
937  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MCAST_MLO_FIRST_TX: first MLO TX, used mostly internally
938  *	for sequence number assignment
939  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK: If not @IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED, this
940  *	frame should be transmitted on the specific link. This really is
941  *	only relevant for frames that do not have data present, and is
942  *	also not used for 802.3 format frames. Note that even if the frame
943  *	is on a specific link, address translation might still apply if
944  *	it's intended for an MLD.
945  *
946  * These flags are used in tx_info->control.flags.
947  */
948 enum mac80211_tx_control_flags {
949 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO	= BIT(0),
950 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE		= BIT(1),
951 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT		= BIT(2),
952 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU			= BIT(3),
953 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT		= BIT(4),
954 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SKIP_MPATH_LOOKUP	= BIT(5),
955 	IEEE80211_TX_INTCFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING	= BIT(6),
956 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_NO_SEQNO		= BIT(7),
957 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_REORDER		= BIT(8),
958 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MCAST_MLO_FIRST_TX	= BIT(9),
959 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK		= 0xf0000000,
960 };
961 
962 #define IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED	0xf
963 #define IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK_UNSPEC	\
964 	u32_encode_bits(IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED, \
965 			IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK)
966 
967 /**
968  * enum mac80211_tx_status_flags - flags to describe transmit status
969  *
970  * @IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_ACK_SIGNAL_VALID: ACK signal is valid
971  *
972  * These flags are used in tx_info->status.flags.
973  */
974 enum mac80211_tx_status_flags {
975 	IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_ACK_SIGNAL_VALID = BIT(0),
976 };
977 
978 /*
979  * This definition is used as a mask to clear all temporary flags, which are
980  * set by the tx handlers for each transmission attempt by the mac80211 stack.
981  */
982 #define IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS (IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK |		      \
983 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT |    \
984 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU |	      \
985 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED |	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK |		      \
986 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU | IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK |	      \
987 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER |    \
988 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC |		      \
989 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC | IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP)
990 
991 /**
992  * enum mac80211_rate_control_flags - per-rate flags set by the
993  *	Rate Control algorithm.
994  *
995  * These flags are set by the Rate control algorithm for each rate during tx,
996  * in the @flags member of struct ieee80211_tx_rate.
997  *
998  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS: Use RTS/CTS exchange for this rate.
999  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT: CTS-to-self protection is required.
1000  *	This is set if the current BSS requires ERP protection.
1001  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE: Use short preamble.
1002  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS: HT rate.
1003  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS: VHT MCS rate, in this case the idx field is split
1004  *	into a higher 4 bits (Nss) and lower 4 bits (MCS number)
1005  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD: Indicates whether this rate should be used in
1006  *	Greenfield mode.
1007  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates if the Channel Width should be 40 MHz.
1008  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 80 MHz transmission
1009  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 160 MHz transmission
1010  *	(80+80 isn't supported yet)
1011  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA: The frame should be transmitted on both of the
1012  *	adjacent 20 MHz channels, if the current channel type is
1013  *	NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS or NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS.
1014  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI: Short Guard interval should be used for this rate.
1015  */
1016 enum mac80211_rate_control_flags {
1017 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS		= BIT(0),
1018 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT		= BIT(1),
1019 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE	= BIT(2),
1020 
1021 	/* rate index is an HT/VHT MCS instead of an index */
1022 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS			= BIT(3),
1023 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD		= BIT(4),
1024 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH		= BIT(5),
1025 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA		= BIT(6),
1026 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI		= BIT(7),
1027 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS			= BIT(8),
1028 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH		= BIT(9),
1029 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH		= BIT(10),
1030 };
1031 
1032 
1033 /* there are 40 bytes if you don't need the rateset to be kept */
1034 #define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 40
1035 
1036 /* if you do need the rateset, then you have less space */
1037 #define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 24
1038 
1039 /* maximum number of rate stages */
1040 #define IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES	4
1041 
1042 /* maximum number of rate table entries */
1043 #define IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE	4
1044 
1045 /**
1046  * struct ieee80211_tx_rate - rate selection/status
1047  *
1048  * @idx: rate index to attempt to send with
1049  * @flags: rate control flags (&enum mac80211_rate_control_flags)
1050  * @count: number of tries in this rate before going to the next rate
1051  *
1052  * A value of -1 for @idx indicates an invalid rate and, if used
1053  * in an array of retry rates, that no more rates should be tried.
1054  *
1055  * When used for transmit status reporting, the driver should
1056  * always report the rate along with the flags it used.
1057  *
1058  * &struct ieee80211_tx_info contains an array of these structs
1059  * in the control information, and it will be filled by the rate
1060  * control algorithm according to what should be sent. For example,
1061  * if this array contains, in the format { <idx>, <count> } the
1062  * information::
1063  *
1064  *    { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 4 }, { -1, 0 }, { -1, 0 }
1065  *
1066  * then this means that the frame should be transmitted
1067  * up to twice at rate 3, up to twice at rate 2, and up to four
1068  * times at rate 1 if it doesn't get acknowledged. Say it gets
1069  * acknowledged by the peer after the fifth attempt, the status
1070  * information should then contain::
1071  *
1072  *   { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 1 }, { -1, 0 } ...
1073  *
1074  * since it was transmitted twice at rate 3, twice at rate 2
1075  * and once at rate 1 after which we received an acknowledgement.
1076  */
1077 struct ieee80211_tx_rate {
1078 	s8 idx;
1079 	u16 count:5,
1080 	    flags:11;
1081 } __packed;
1082 
1083 #define IEEE80211_MAX_TX_RETRY		31
1084 
1085 static inline void ieee80211_rate_set_vht(struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate,
1086 					  u8 mcs, u8 nss)
1087 {
1088 	WARN_ON(mcs & ~0xF);
1089 	WARN_ON((nss - 1) & ~0x7);
1090 	rate->idx = ((nss - 1) << 4) | mcs;
1091 }
1092 
1093 static inline u8
1094 ieee80211_rate_get_vht_mcs(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
1095 {
1096 	return rate->idx & 0xF;
1097 }
1098 
1099 static inline u8
1100 ieee80211_rate_get_vht_nss(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
1101 {
1102 	return (rate->idx >> 4) + 1;
1103 }
1104 
1105 /**
1106  * struct ieee80211_tx_info - skb transmit information
1107  *
1108  * This structure is placed in skb->cb for three uses:
1109  *  (1) mac80211 TX control - mac80211 tells the driver what to do
1110  *  (2) driver internal use (if applicable)
1111  *  (3) TX status information - driver tells mac80211 what happened
1112  *
1113  * @flags: transmit info flags, defined above
1114  * @band: the band to transmit on (use e.g. for checking for races),
1115  *	not valid if the interface is an MLD since we won't know which
1116  *	link the frame will be transmitted on
1117  * @hw_queue: HW queue to put the frame on, skb_get_queue_mapping() gives the AC
1118  * @ack_frame_id: internal frame ID for TX status, used internally
1119  * @tx_time_est: TX time estimate in units of 4us, used internally
1120  * @control: union part for control data
1121  * @control.rates: TX rates array to try
1122  * @control.rts_cts_rate_idx: rate for RTS or CTS
1123  * @control.use_rts: use RTS
1124  * @control.use_cts_prot: use RTS/CTS
1125  * @control.short_preamble: use short preamble (CCK only)
1126  * @control.skip_table: skip externally configured rate table
1127  * @control.jiffies: timestamp for expiry on powersave clients
1128  * @control.vif: virtual interface (may be NULL)
1129  * @control.hw_key: key to encrypt with (may be NULL)
1130  * @control.flags: control flags, see &enum mac80211_tx_control_flags
1131  * @control.enqueue_time: enqueue time (for iTXQs)
1132  * @driver_rates: alias to @control.rates to reserve space
1133  * @pad: padding
1134  * @rate_driver_data: driver use area if driver needs @control.rates
1135  * @status: union part for status data
1136  * @status.rates: attempted rates
1137  * @status.ack_signal: ACK signal
1138  * @status.ampdu_ack_len: AMPDU ack length
1139  * @status.ampdu_len: AMPDU length
1140  * @status.antenna: (legacy, kept only for iwlegacy)
1141  * @status.tx_time: airtime consumed for transmission; note this is only
1142  *	used for WMM AC, not for airtime fairness
1143  * @status.flags: status flags, see &enum mac80211_tx_status_flags
1144  * @status.status_driver_data: driver use area
1145  * @ack: union part for pure ACK data
1146  * @ack.cookie: cookie for the ACK
1147  * @driver_data: array of driver_data pointers
1148  * @ampdu_ack_len: number of acked aggregated frames.
1149  * 	relevant only if IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU was set.
1150  * @ampdu_len: number of aggregated frames.
1151  * 	relevant only if IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU was set.
1152  * @ack_signal: signal strength of the ACK frame
1153  */
1154 struct ieee80211_tx_info {
1155 	/* common information */
1156 	u32 flags;
1157 	u32 band:3,
1158 	    ack_frame_id:13,
1159 	    hw_queue:4,
1160 	    tx_time_est:10;
1161 	/* 2 free bits */
1162 
1163 	union {
1164 		struct {
1165 			union {
1166 				/* rate control */
1167 				struct {
1168 					struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[
1169 						IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1170 					s8 rts_cts_rate_idx;
1171 					u8 use_rts:1;
1172 					u8 use_cts_prot:1;
1173 					u8 short_preamble:1;
1174 					u8 skip_table:1;
1175 					/* 2 bytes free */
1176 				};
1177 				/* only needed before rate control */
1178 				unsigned long jiffies;
1179 			};
1180 			/* NB: vif can be NULL for injected frames */
1181 			struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
1182 			struct ieee80211_key_conf *hw_key;
1183 			u32 flags;
1184 			codel_time_t enqueue_time;
1185 		} control;
1186 		struct {
1187 			u64 cookie;
1188 		} ack;
1189 		struct {
1190 			struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1191 			s32 ack_signal;
1192 			u8 ampdu_ack_len;
1193 			u8 ampdu_len;
1194 			u8 antenna;
1195 			u16 tx_time;
1196 			u8 flags;
1197 			void *status_driver_data[18 / sizeof(void *)];
1198 		} status;
1199 		struct {
1200 			struct ieee80211_tx_rate driver_rates[
1201 				IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1202 			u8 pad[4];
1203 
1204 			void *rate_driver_data[
1205 				IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)];
1206 		};
1207 		void *driver_data[
1208 			IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)];
1209 	};
1210 };
1211 
1212 static inline u16
1213 ieee80211_info_set_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info, u16 tx_time_est)
1214 {
1215 	/* We only have 10 bits in tx_time_est, so store airtime
1216 	 * in increments of 4us and clamp the maximum to 2**12-1
1217 	 */
1218 	info->tx_time_est = min_t(u16, tx_time_est, 4095) >> 2;
1219 	return info->tx_time_est << 2;
1220 }
1221 
1222 static inline u16
1223 ieee80211_info_get_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
1224 {
1225 	return info->tx_time_est << 2;
1226 }
1227 
1228 /***
1229  * struct ieee80211_rate_status - mrr stage for status path
1230  *
1231  * This struct is used in struct ieee80211_tx_status to provide drivers a
1232  * dynamic way to report about used rates and power levels per packet.
1233  *
1234  * @rate_idx The actual used rate.
1235  * @try_count How often the rate was tried.
1236  * @tx_power_idx An idx into the ieee80211_hw->tx_power_levels list of the
1237  * 	corresponding wifi hardware. The idx shall point to the power level
1238  * 	that was used when sending the packet.
1239  */
1240 struct ieee80211_rate_status {
1241 	struct rate_info rate_idx;
1242 	u8 try_count;
1243 	u8 tx_power_idx;
1244 };
1245 
1246 /**
1247  * struct ieee80211_tx_status - extended tx status info for rate control
1248  *
1249  * @sta: Station that the packet was transmitted for
1250  * @info: Basic tx status information
1251  * @skb: Packet skb (can be NULL if not provided by the driver)
1252  * @rates: Mrr stages that were used when sending the packet
1253  * @n_rates: Number of mrr stages (count of instances for @rates)
1254  * @free_list: list where processed skbs are stored to be free'd by the driver
1255  * @ack_hwtstamp: Hardware timestamp of the received ack in nanoseconds
1256  *	Only needed for Timing measurement and Fine timing measurement action
1257  *	frames. Only reported by devices that have timestamping enabled.
1258  */
1259 struct ieee80211_tx_status {
1260 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
1261 	struct ieee80211_tx_info *info;
1262 	struct sk_buff *skb;
1263 	struct ieee80211_rate_status *rates;
1264 	ktime_t ack_hwtstamp;
1265 	u8 n_rates;
1266 
1267 	struct list_head *free_list;
1268 };
1269 
1270 /**
1271  * struct ieee80211_scan_ies - descriptors for different blocks of IEs
1272  *
1273  * This structure is used to point to different blocks of IEs in HW scan
1274  * and scheduled scan. These blocks contain the IEs passed by userspace
1275  * and the ones generated by mac80211.
1276  *
1277  * @ies: pointers to band specific IEs.
1278  * @len: lengths of band_specific IEs.
1279  * @common_ies: IEs for all bands (especially vendor specific ones)
1280  * @common_ie_len: length of the common_ies
1281  */
1282 struct ieee80211_scan_ies {
1283 	const u8 *ies[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
1284 	size_t len[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
1285 	const u8 *common_ies;
1286 	size_t common_ie_len;
1287 };
1288 
1289 
1290 static inline struct ieee80211_tx_info *IEEE80211_SKB_CB(struct sk_buff *skb)
1291 {
1292 	return (struct ieee80211_tx_info *)skb->cb;
1293 }
1294 
1295 static inline struct ieee80211_rx_status *IEEE80211_SKB_RXCB(struct sk_buff *skb)
1296 {
1297 	return (struct ieee80211_rx_status *)skb->cb;
1298 }
1299 
1300 /**
1301  * ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status - clear TX status
1302  *
1303  * @info: The &struct ieee80211_tx_info to be cleared.
1304  *
1305  * When the driver passes an skb back to mac80211, it must report
1306  * a number of things in TX status. This function clears everything
1307  * in the TX status but the rate control information (it does clear
1308  * the count since you need to fill that in anyway).
1309  *
1310  * NOTE: While the rates array is kept intact, this will wipe all of the
1311  *	 driver_data fields in info, so it's up to the driver to restore
1312  *	 any fields it needs after calling this helper.
1313  */
1314 static inline void
1315 ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
1316 {
1317 	int i;
1318 
1319 	BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) !=
1320 		     offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, control.rates));
1321 	BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) !=
1322 		     offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, driver_rates));
1323 	BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) != 8);
1324 	/* clear the rate counts */
1325 	for (i = 0; i < IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES; i++)
1326 		info->status.rates[i].count = 0;
1327 	memset_after(&info->status, 0, rates);
1328 }
1329 
1330 
1331 /**
1332  * enum mac80211_rx_flags - receive flags
1333  *
1334  * These flags are used with the @flag member of &struct ieee80211_rx_status.
1335  * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR: Michael MIC error was reported on this frame.
1336  *	Use together with %RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED.
1337  * @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED: This frame was decrypted in hardware.
1338  * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED: the Michael MIC is stripped off this frame,
1339  *	verification has been done by the hardware.
1340  * @RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED: The IV and ICV are stripped from this frame.
1341  *	If this flag is set, the stack cannot do any replay detection
1342  *	hence the driver or hardware will have to do that.
1343  * @RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED: Currently only valid for CCMP/GCMP frames, this
1344  *	flag indicates that the PN was verified for replay protection.
1345  *	Note that this flag is also currently only supported when a frame
1346  *	is also decrypted (ie. @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED must be set)
1347  * @RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED: The driver should set this flag if it did
1348  *	de-duplication by itself.
1349  * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC: Set this flag if the FCS check failed on
1350  *	the frame.
1351  * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC: Set this flag if the PCLP check failed on
1352  *	the frame.
1353  * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1354  *	field) is valid and contains the time the first symbol of the MPDU
1355  *	was received. This is useful in monitor mode and for proper IBSS
1356  *	merging.
1357  * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1358  *	field) is valid and contains the time the last symbol of the MPDU
1359  *	(including FCS) was received.
1360  * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1361  *	field) is valid and contains the time the SYNC preamble was received.
1362  * @RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL: The signal strength value is not present.
1363  *	Valid only for data frames (mainly A-MPDU)
1364  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS: A-MPDU details are known, in particular the reference
1365  *	number (@ampdu_reference) must be populated and be a distinct number for
1366  *	each A-MPDU
1367  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN: last subframe is known, should be set on all
1368  *	subframes of a single A-MPDU
1369  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST: this subframe is the last subframe of the A-MPDU
1370  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR: A delimiter CRC error has been detected
1371  *	on this subframe
1372  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_KNOWN: The delimiter CRC field is known (the CRC
1373  *	is stored in the @ampdu_delimiter_crc field)
1374  * @RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED: The mic was stripped of this packet. Decryption was
1375  *	done by the hardware
1376  * @RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR: Report frame only to monitor interfaces without
1377  *	processing it in any regular way.
1378  *	This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report
1379  *	them for sniffing purposes.
1380  * @RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR: Process and report frame to all interfaces except
1381  *	monitor interfaces.
1382  *	This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report
1383  *	them for sniffing purposes.
1384  * @RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE: Some drivers may prefer to report separate A-MSDU
1385  *	subframes instead of a one huge frame for performance reasons.
1386  *	All, but the last MSDU from an A-MSDU should have this flag set. E.g.
1387  *	if an A-MSDU has 3 frames, the first 2 must have the flag set, while
1388  *	the 3rd (last) one must not have this flag set. The flag is used to
1389  *	deal with retransmission/duplication recovery properly since A-MSDU
1390  *	subframes share the same sequence number. Reported subframes can be
1391  *	either regular MSDU or singly A-MSDUs. Subframes must not be
1392  *	interleaved with other frames.
1393  * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_TLV_AT_END: This frame contains radiotap TLVs in the
1394  *	skb->data (before the 802.11 header).
1395  *	If used, the SKB's mac_header pointer must be set to point
1396  *	to the 802.11 header after the TLVs, and any padding added after TLV
1397  *	data to align to 4 must be cleared by the driver putting the TLVs
1398  *	in the skb.
1399  * @RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN: Allow the same PN as same packet before.
1400  *	This is used for AMSDU subframes which can have the same PN as
1401  *	the first subframe.
1402  * @RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED: The ICV is stripped from this frame. CRC checking must
1403  *	be done in the hardware.
1404  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT: Value of the EOF bit in the A-MPDU delimiter for this
1405  *	frame
1406  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN: The EOF value is known
1407  * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE: HE radiotap data is present
1408  *	(&struct ieee80211_radiotap_he, mac80211 will fill in
1409  *
1410  *	 - DATA3_DATA_MCS
1411  *	 - DATA3_DATA_DCM
1412  *	 - DATA3_CODING
1413  *	 - DATA5_GI
1414  *	 - DATA5_DATA_BW_RU_ALLOC
1415  *	 - DATA6_NSTS
1416  *	 - DATA3_STBC
1417  *
1418  *	from the RX info data, so leave those zeroed when building this data)
1419  * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE_MU: HE MU radiotap data is present
1420  *	(&struct ieee80211_radiotap_he_mu)
1421  * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_LSIG: L-SIG radiotap data is present
1422  * @RX_FLAG_NO_PSDU: use the frame only for radiotap reporting, with
1423  *	the "0-length PSDU" field included there.  The value for it is
1424  *	in &struct ieee80211_rx_status.  Note that if this value isn't
1425  *	known the frame shouldn't be reported.
1426  * @RX_FLAG_8023: the frame has an 802.3 header (decap offload performed by
1427  *	hardware or driver)
1428  */
1429 enum mac80211_rx_flags {
1430 	RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR		= BIT(0),
1431 	RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED		= BIT(1),
1432 	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START	= BIT(2),
1433 	RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED		= BIT(3),
1434 	RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED		= BIT(4),
1435 	RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC		= BIT(5),
1436 	RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC 	= BIT(6),
1437 	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START		= BIT(7),
1438 	RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL		= BIT(8),
1439 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS		= BIT(9),
1440 	RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED		= BIT(10),
1441 	RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED		= BIT(11),
1442 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN	= BIT(12),
1443 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST		= BIT(13),
1444 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR	= BIT(14),
1445 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_KNOWN	= BIT(15),
1446 	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END		= BIT(16),
1447 	RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR		= BIT(17),
1448 	RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR		= BIT(18),
1449 	RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE		= BIT(19),
1450 	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_TLV_AT_END	= BIT(20),
1451 	RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED		= BIT(21),
1452 	RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN		= BIT(22),
1453 	RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED		= BIT(23),
1454 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT		= BIT(24),
1455 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN	= BIT(25),
1456 	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE		= BIT(26),
1457 	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE_MU		= BIT(27),
1458 	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_LSIG		= BIT(28),
1459 	RX_FLAG_NO_PSDU			= BIT(29),
1460 	RX_FLAG_8023			= BIT(30),
1461 };
1462 
1463 /**
1464  * enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags - MCS & bandwidth flags
1465  *
1466  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE: Short preamble was used for this frame
1467  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI: Short guard interval was used
1468  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF: This frame was received in a HT-greenfield transmission,
1469  *	if the driver fills this value it should add
1470  *	%IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_FMT
1471  *	to @hw.radiotap_mcs_details to advertise that fact.
1472  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC: LDPC was used
1473  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK: STBC 2 bit bitmask. 1 - Nss=1, 2 - Nss=2, 3 - Nss=3
1474  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_BF: packet was beamformed
1475  */
1476 enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags {
1477 	RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE		= BIT(0),
1478 	RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI		= BIT(2),
1479 	RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF		= BIT(3),
1480 	RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK		= BIT(4) | BIT(5),
1481 	RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC		= BIT(6),
1482 	RX_ENC_FLAG_BF			= BIT(7),
1483 };
1484 
1485 #define RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_SHIFT		4
1486 
1487 enum mac80211_rx_encoding {
1488 	RX_ENC_LEGACY = 0,
1489 	RX_ENC_HT,
1490 	RX_ENC_VHT,
1491 	RX_ENC_HE,
1492 	RX_ENC_EHT,
1493 };
1494 
1495 /**
1496  * struct ieee80211_rx_status - receive status
1497  *
1498  * The low-level driver should provide this information (the subset
1499  * supported by hardware) to the 802.11 code with each received
1500  * frame, in the skb's control buffer (cb).
1501  *
1502  * @mactime: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization Function
1503  * 	(TSF) timer when the first data symbol (MPDU) arrived at the hardware.
1504  * @boottime_ns: CLOCK_BOOTTIME timestamp the frame was received at, this is
1505  *	needed only for beacons and probe responses that update the scan cache.
1506  * @ack_tx_hwtstamp: Hardware timestamp for the ack TX in nanoseconds. Only
1507  *	needed for Timing measurement and Fine timing measurement action frames.
1508  *	Only reported by devices that have timestamping enabled.
1509  * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, mac80211 doesn't use
1510  *	it but can store it and pass it back to the driver for synchronisation
1511  * @band: the active band when this frame was received
1512  * @freq: frequency the radio was tuned to when receiving this frame, in MHz
1513  *	This field must be set for management frames, but isn't strictly needed
1514  *	for data (other) frames - for those it only affects radiotap reporting.
1515  * @freq_offset: @freq has a positive offset of 500Khz.
1516  * @signal: signal strength when receiving this frame, either in dBm, in dB or
1517  *	unspecified depending on the hardware capabilities flags
1518  *	@IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_*
1519  * @chains: bitmask of receive chains for which separate signal strength
1520  *	values were filled.
1521  * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength, in dBm (unlike @signal, doesn't
1522  *	support dB or unspecified units)
1523  * @antenna: antenna used
1524  * @rate_idx: index of data rate into band's supported rates or MCS index if
1525  *	HT or VHT is used (%RX_FLAG_HT/%RX_FLAG_VHT)
1526  * @nss: number of streams (VHT, HE and EHT only)
1527  * @flag: %RX_FLAG_\*
1528  * @encoding: &enum mac80211_rx_encoding
1529  * @bw: &enum rate_info_bw
1530  * @enc_flags: uses bits from &enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags
1531  * @he_ru: HE RU, from &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc
1532  * @he_gi: HE GI, from &enum nl80211_he_gi
1533  * @he_dcm: HE DCM value
1534  * @eht: EHT specific rate information
1535  * @eht.ru: EHT RU, from &enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc
1536  * @eht.gi: EHT GI, from &enum nl80211_eht_gi
1537  * @rx_flags: internal RX flags for mac80211
1538  * @ampdu_reference: A-MPDU reference number, must be a different value for
1539  *	each A-MPDU but the same for each subframe within one A-MPDU
1540  * @ampdu_delimiter_crc: A-MPDU delimiter CRC
1541  * @zero_length_psdu_type: radiotap type of the 0-length PSDU
1542  * @link_valid: if the link which is identified by @link_id is valid. This flag
1543  *	is set only when connection is MLO.
1544  * @link_id: id of the link used to receive the packet. This is used along with
1545  *	@link_valid.
1546  */
1547 struct ieee80211_rx_status {
1548 	u64 mactime;
1549 	union {
1550 		u64 boottime_ns;
1551 		ktime_t ack_tx_hwtstamp;
1552 	};
1553 	u32 device_timestamp;
1554 	u32 ampdu_reference;
1555 	u32 flag;
1556 	u16 freq: 13, freq_offset: 1;
1557 	u8 enc_flags;
1558 	u8 encoding:3, bw:4;
1559 	union {
1560 		struct {
1561 			u8 he_ru:3;
1562 			u8 he_gi:2;
1563 			u8 he_dcm:1;
1564 		};
1565 		struct {
1566 			u8 ru:4;
1567 			u8 gi:2;
1568 		} eht;
1569 	};
1570 	u8 rate_idx;
1571 	u8 nss;
1572 	u8 rx_flags;
1573 	u8 band;
1574 	u8 antenna;
1575 	s8 signal;
1576 	u8 chains;
1577 	s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
1578 	u8 ampdu_delimiter_crc;
1579 	u8 zero_length_psdu_type;
1580 	u8 link_valid:1, link_id:4;
1581 };
1582 
1583 static inline u32
1584 ieee80211_rx_status_to_khz(struct ieee80211_rx_status *rx_status)
1585 {
1586 	return MHZ_TO_KHZ(rx_status->freq) +
1587 	       (rx_status->freq_offset ? 500 : 0);
1588 }
1589 
1590 /**
1591  * enum ieee80211_conf_flags - configuration flags
1592  *
1593  * Flags to define PHY configuration options
1594  *
1595  * @IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR: there's a monitor interface present -- use this
1596  *	to determine for example whether to calculate timestamps for packets
1597  *	or not, do not use instead of filter flags!
1598  * @IEEE80211_CONF_PS: Enable 802.11 power save mode (managed mode only).
1599  *	This is the power save mode defined by IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2,
1600  *	meaning that the hardware still wakes up for beacons, is able to
1601  *	transmit frames and receive the possible acknowledgment frames.
1602  *	Not to be confused with hardware specific wakeup/sleep states,
1603  *	driver is responsible for that. See the section "Powersave support"
1604  *	for more.
1605  * @IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE: The device is running, but idle; if the flag is set
1606  *	the driver should be prepared to handle configuration requests but
1607  *	may turn the device off as much as possible. Typically, this flag will
1608  *	be set when an interface is set UP but not associated or scanning, but
1609  *	it can also be unset in that case when monitor interfaces are active.
1610  * @IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL: The device is currently not on its main
1611  *	operating channel.
1612  */
1613 enum ieee80211_conf_flags {
1614 	IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR		= (1<<0),
1615 	IEEE80211_CONF_PS		= (1<<1),
1616 	IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE		= (1<<2),
1617 	IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL	= (1<<3),
1618 };
1619 
1620 
1621 /**
1622  * enum ieee80211_conf_changed - denotes which configuration changed
1623  *
1624  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL: the listen interval changed
1625  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR: the monitor flag changed
1626  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS: the PS flag or dynamic PS timeout changed
1627  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER: the TX power changed
1628  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL: the channel/channel_type changed
1629  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS: retry limits changed
1630  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE: Idle flag changed
1631  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS: Spatial multiplexing powersave mode changed
1632  *	Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used,
1633  *	otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed.
1634  */
1635 enum ieee80211_conf_changed {
1636 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS		= BIT(1),
1637 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL	= BIT(2),
1638 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR		= BIT(3),
1639 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS		= BIT(4),
1640 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER		= BIT(5),
1641 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL		= BIT(6),
1642 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS	= BIT(7),
1643 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE		= BIT(8),
1644 };
1645 
1646 /**
1647  * enum ieee80211_smps_mode - spatial multiplexing power save mode
1648  *
1649  * @IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC: automatic
1650  * @IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF: off
1651  * @IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC: static
1652  * @IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC: dynamic
1653  * @IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES: internal, don't use
1654  */
1655 enum ieee80211_smps_mode {
1656 	IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC,
1657 	IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF,
1658 	IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC,
1659 	IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC,
1660 
1661 	/* keep last */
1662 	IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES,
1663 };
1664 
1665 /**
1666  * struct ieee80211_conf - configuration of the device
1667  *
1668  * This struct indicates how the driver shall configure the hardware.
1669  *
1670  * @flags: configuration flags defined above
1671  *
1672  * @listen_interval: listen interval in units of beacon interval
1673  * @ps_dtim_period: The DTIM period of the AP we're connected to, for use
1674  *	in power saving. Power saving will not be enabled until a beacon
1675  *	has been received and the DTIM period is known.
1676  * @dynamic_ps_timeout: The dynamic powersave timeout (in ms), see the
1677  *	powersave documentation below. This variable is valid only when
1678  *	the CONF_PS flag is set.
1679  *
1680  * @power_level: requested transmit power (in dBm), backward compatibility
1681  *	value only that is set to the minimum of all interfaces
1682  *
1683  * @chandef: the channel definition to tune to
1684  * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled
1685  *
1686  * @long_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "long" frame
1687  *	(a frame not RTS protected), called "dot11LongRetryLimit" in 802.11,
1688  *	but actually means the number of transmissions not the number of retries
1689  * @short_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "short"
1690  *	frame, called "dot11ShortRetryLimit" in 802.11, but actually means the
1691  *	number of transmissions not the number of retries
1692  *
1693  * @smps_mode: spatial multiplexing powersave mode; note that
1694  *	%IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC is used when the device is not
1695  *	configured for an HT channel.
1696  *	Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used,
1697  *	otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed.
1698  */
1699 struct ieee80211_conf {
1700 	u32 flags;
1701 	int power_level, dynamic_ps_timeout;
1702 
1703 	u16 listen_interval;
1704 	u8 ps_dtim_period;
1705 
1706 	u8 long_frame_max_tx_count, short_frame_max_tx_count;
1707 
1708 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1709 	bool radar_enabled;
1710 	enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
1711 };
1712 
1713 /**
1714  * struct ieee80211_channel_switch - holds the channel switch data
1715  *
1716  * The information provided in this structure is required for channel switch
1717  * operation.
1718  *
1719  * @timestamp: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization
1720  *	Function (TSF) timer when the frame containing the channel switch
1721  *	announcement was received. This is simply the rx.mactime parameter
1722  *	the driver passed into mac80211.
1723  * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, this is the
1724  *	rx.device_timestamp parameter the driver passed to mac80211.
1725  * @block_tx: Indicates whether transmission must be blocked before the
1726  *	scheduled channel switch, as indicated by the AP.
1727  * @chandef: the new channel to switch to
1728  * @count: the number of TBTT's until the channel switch event
1729  * @delay: maximum delay between the time the AP transmitted the last beacon in
1730   *	current channel and the expected time of the first beacon in the new
1731   *	channel, expressed in TU.
1732  */
1733 struct ieee80211_channel_switch {
1734 	u64 timestamp;
1735 	u32 device_timestamp;
1736 	bool block_tx;
1737 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1738 	u8 count;
1739 	u32 delay;
1740 };
1741 
1742 /**
1743  * enum ieee80211_vif_flags - virtual interface flags
1744  *
1745  * @IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER: the device performs beacon filtering
1746  *	on this virtual interface to avoid unnecessary CPU wakeups
1747  * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI: the device can do connection quality
1748  *	monitoring on this virtual interface -- i.e. it can monitor
1749  *	connection quality related parameters, such as the RSSI level and
1750  *	provide notifications if configured trigger levels are reached.
1751  * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD: The device can do U-APSD for this
1752  *	interface. This flag should be set during interface addition,
1753  *	but may be set/cleared as late as authentication to an AP. It is
1754  *	only valid for managed/station mode interfaces.
1755  * @IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE: request to handle NOA attributes
1756  *	and send P2P_PS notification to the driver if NOA changed, even
1757  *	this is not pure P2P vif.
1758  * @IEEE80211_VIF_DISABLE_SMPS_OVERRIDE: disable user configuration of
1759  *	SMPS mode via debugfs.
1760  */
1761 enum ieee80211_vif_flags {
1762 	IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER		= BIT(0),
1763 	IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI		= BIT(1),
1764 	IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD		= BIT(2),
1765 	IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE		= BIT(3),
1766 	IEEE80211_VIF_DISABLE_SMPS_OVERRIDE	= BIT(4),
1767 };
1768 
1769 
1770 /**
1771  * enum ieee80211_offload_flags - virtual interface offload flags
1772  *
1773  * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_ENABLED: tx encapsulation offload is enabled
1774  *	The driver supports sending frames passed as 802.3 frames by mac80211.
1775  *	It must also support sending 802.11 packets for the same interface.
1776  * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_4ADDR: support 4-address mode encapsulation offload
1777  * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_DECAP_ENABLED: rx encapsulation offload is enabled
1778  *	The driver supports passing received 802.11 frames as 802.3 frames to
1779  *	mac80211.
1780  */
1781 
1782 enum ieee80211_offload_flags {
1783 	IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_ENABLED		= BIT(0),
1784 	IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_4ADDR		= BIT(1),
1785 	IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_DECAP_ENABLED		= BIT(2),
1786 };
1787 
1788 /**
1789  * struct ieee80211_vif_cfg - interface configuration
1790  * @assoc: association status
1791  * @ibss_joined: indicates whether this station is part of an IBSS or not
1792  * @ibss_creator: indicates if a new IBSS network is being created
1793  * @ps: power-save mode (STA only). This flag is NOT affected by
1794  *	offchannel/dynamic_ps operations.
1795  * @aid: association ID number, valid only when @assoc is true
1796  * @eml_cap: EML capabilities as described in P802.11be_D2.2 Figure 9-1002k.
1797  * @eml_med_sync_delay: Medium Synchronization delay as described in
1798  *	P802.11be_D2.2 Figure 9-1002j.
1799  * @arp_addr_list: List of IPv4 addresses for hardware ARP filtering. The
1800  *	may filter ARP queries targeted for other addresses than listed here.
1801  *	The driver must allow ARP queries targeted for all address listed here
1802  *	to pass through. An empty list implies no ARP queries need to pass.
1803  * @arp_addr_cnt: Number of addresses currently on the list. Note that this
1804  *	may be larger than %IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN (the arp_addr_list
1805  *	array size), it's up to the driver what to do in that case.
1806  * @ssid: The SSID of the current vif. Valid in AP and IBSS mode.
1807  * @ssid_len: Length of SSID given in @ssid.
1808  * @s1g: BSS is S1G BSS (affects Association Request format).
1809  * @idle: This interface is idle. There's also a global idle flag in the
1810  *	hardware config which may be more appropriate depending on what
1811  *	your driver/device needs to do.
1812  * @ap_addr: AP MLD address, or BSSID for non-MLO connections
1813  *	(station mode only)
1814  */
1815 struct ieee80211_vif_cfg {
1816 	/* association related data */
1817 	bool assoc, ibss_joined;
1818 	bool ibss_creator;
1819 	bool ps;
1820 	u16 aid;
1821 	u16 eml_cap;
1822 	u16 eml_med_sync_delay;
1823 
1824 	__be32 arp_addr_list[IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN];
1825 	int arp_addr_cnt;
1826 	u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
1827 	size_t ssid_len;
1828 	bool s1g;
1829 	bool idle;
1830 	u8 ap_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
1831 };
1832 
1833 /**
1834  * struct ieee80211_vif - per-interface data
1835  *
1836  * Data in this structure is continually present for driver
1837  * use during the life of a virtual interface.
1838  *
1839  * @type: type of this virtual interface
1840  * @cfg: vif configuration, see &struct ieee80211_vif_cfg
1841  * @bss_conf: BSS configuration for this interface, either our own
1842  *	or the BSS we're associated to
1843  * @link_conf: in case of MLD, the per-link BSS configuration,
1844  *	indexed by link ID
1845  * @valid_links: bitmap of valid links, or 0 for non-MLO.
1846  * @active_links: The bitmap of active links, or 0 for non-MLO.
1847  *	The driver shouldn't change this directly, but use the
1848  *	API calls meant for that purpose.
1849  * @dormant_links: bitmap of valid but disabled links, or 0 for non-MLO.
1850  *	Must be a subset of valid_links.
1851  * @addr: address of this interface
1852  * @p2p: indicates whether this AP or STA interface is a p2p
1853  *	interface, i.e. a GO or p2p-sta respectively
1854  * @netdev_features: tx netdev features supported by the hardware for this
1855  *	vif. mac80211 initializes this to hw->netdev_features, and the driver
1856  *	can mask out specific tx features. mac80211 will handle software fixup
1857  *	for masked offloads (GSO, CSUM)
1858  * @driver_flags: flags/capabilities the driver has for this interface,
1859  *	these need to be set (or cleared) when the interface is added
1860  *	or, if supported by the driver, the interface type is changed
1861  *	at runtime, mac80211 will never touch this field
1862  * @offload_flags: hardware offload capabilities/flags for this interface.
1863  *	These are initialized by mac80211 before calling .add_interface,
1864  *	.change_interface or .update_vif_offload and updated by the driver
1865  *	within these ops, based on supported features or runtime change
1866  *	restrictions.
1867  * @hw_queue: hardware queue for each AC
1868  * @cab_queue: content-after-beacon (DTIM beacon really) queue, AP mode only
1869  * @debugfs_dir: debugfs dentry, can be used by drivers to create own per
1870  *	interface debug files. Note that it will be NULL for the virtual
1871  *	monitor interface (if that is requested.)
1872  * @probe_req_reg: probe requests should be reported to mac80211 for this
1873  *	interface.
1874  * @rx_mcast_action_reg: multicast Action frames should be reported to mac80211
1875  *	for this interface.
1876  * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
1877  *	sizeof(void \*).
1878  * @txq: the multicast data TX queue
1879  * @offload_flags: 802.3 -> 802.11 enapsulation offload flags, see
1880  *	&enum ieee80211_offload_flags.
1881  * @mbssid_tx_vif: Pointer to the transmitting interface if MBSSID is enabled.
1882  */
1883 struct ieee80211_vif {
1884 	enum nl80211_iftype type;
1885 	struct ieee80211_vif_cfg cfg;
1886 	struct ieee80211_bss_conf bss_conf;
1887 	struct ieee80211_bss_conf __rcu *link_conf[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
1888 	u16 valid_links, active_links, dormant_links;
1889 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
1890 	bool p2p;
1891 
1892 	u8 cab_queue;
1893 	u8 hw_queue[IEEE80211_NUM_ACS];
1894 
1895 	struct ieee80211_txq *txq;
1896 
1897 	netdev_features_t netdev_features;
1898 	u32 driver_flags;
1899 	u32 offload_flags;
1900 
1901 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS
1902 	struct dentry *debugfs_dir;
1903 #endif
1904 
1905 	bool probe_req_reg;
1906 	bool rx_mcast_action_reg;
1907 
1908 	struct ieee80211_vif *mbssid_tx_vif;
1909 
1910 	/* must be last */
1911 	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
1912 };
1913 
1914 /**
1915  * ieee80211_vif_usable_links - Return the usable links for the vif
1916  * @vif: the vif for which the usable links are requested
1917  * Return: the usable link bitmap
1918  */
1919 static inline u16 ieee80211_vif_usable_links(const struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
1920 {
1921 	return vif->valid_links & ~vif->dormant_links;
1922 }
1923 
1924 /**
1925  * ieee80211_vif_is_mld - Returns true iff the vif is an MLD one
1926  * @vif: the vif
1927  * Return: %true if the vif is an MLD, %false otherwise.
1928  */
1929 static inline bool ieee80211_vif_is_mld(const struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
1930 {
1931 	/* valid_links != 0 indicates this vif is an MLD */
1932 	return vif->valid_links != 0;
1933 }
1934 
1935 #define for_each_vif_active_link(vif, link, link_id)				\
1936 	for (link_id = 0; link_id < ARRAY_SIZE((vif)->link_conf); link_id++)	\
1937 		if ((!(vif)->active_links ||					\
1938 		     (vif)->active_links & BIT(link_id)) &&			\
1939 		    (link = rcu_dereference((vif)->link_conf[link_id])))
1940 
1941 static inline bool ieee80211_vif_is_mesh(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
1942 {
1943 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_MESH
1944 	return vif->type == NL80211_IFTYPE_MESH_POINT;
1945 #endif
1946 	return false;
1947 }
1948 
1949 /**
1950  * wdev_to_ieee80211_vif - return a vif struct from a wdev
1951  * @wdev: the wdev to get the vif for
1952  *
1953  * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs
1954  * (like the vendor commands) that get a wdev.
1955  *
1956  * Note that this function may return %NULL if the given wdev isn't
1957  * associated with a vif that the driver knows about (e.g. monitor
1958  * or AP_VLAN interfaces.)
1959  */
1960 struct ieee80211_vif *wdev_to_ieee80211_vif(struct wireless_dev *wdev);
1961 
1962 /**
1963  * ieee80211_vif_to_wdev - return a wdev struct from a vif
1964  * @vif: the vif to get the wdev for
1965  *
1966  * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs
1967  * (like the vendor commands) that needs to get the wdev for a vif.
1968  * This can also be useful to get the netdev associated to a vif.
1969  */
1970 struct wireless_dev *ieee80211_vif_to_wdev(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
1971 
1972 /**
1973  * lockdep_vif_mutex_held - for lockdep checks on link poiners
1974  * @vif: the interface to check
1975  */
1976 static inline bool lockdep_vif_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
1977 {
1978 	return lockdep_is_held(&ieee80211_vif_to_wdev(vif)->mtx);
1979 }
1980 
1981 #define link_conf_dereference_protected(vif, link_id)		\
1982 	rcu_dereference_protected((vif)->link_conf[link_id],	\
1983 				  lockdep_vif_mutex_held(vif))
1984 
1985 #define link_conf_dereference_check(vif, link_id)		\
1986 	rcu_dereference_check((vif)->link_conf[link_id],	\
1987 			      lockdep_vif_mutex_held(vif))
1988 
1989 /**
1990  * enum ieee80211_key_flags - key flags
1991  *
1992  * These flags are used for communication about keys between the driver
1993  * and mac80211, with the @flags parameter of &struct ieee80211_key_conf.
1994  *
1995  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV: This flag should be set by the
1996  *	driver to indicate that it requires IV generation for this
1997  *	particular key. Setting this flag does not necessarily mean that SKBs
1998  *	will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or MIC.
1999  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC: This flag should be set by
2000  *	the driver for a TKIP key if it requires Michael MIC
2001  *	generation in software.
2002  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE: Set by mac80211, this flag indicates
2003  *	that the key is pairwise rather then a shared key.
2004  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX: This flag should be set by the driver for a
2005  *	CCMP/GCMP key if it requires CCMP/GCMP encryption of management frames
2006  *	(MFP) to be done in software.
2007  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver
2008  *	if space should be prepared for the IV, but the IV
2009  *	itself should not be generated. Do not set together with
2010  *	@IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV on the same key. Setting this flag does
2011  *	not necessarily mean that SKBs will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or
2012  *	MIC.
2013  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT: This key will be used to decrypt received
2014  *	management frames. The flag can help drivers that have a hardware
2015  *	crypto implementation that doesn't deal with management frames
2016  *	properly by allowing them to not upload the keys to hardware and
2017  *	fall back to software crypto. Note that this flag deals only with
2018  *	RX, if your crypto engine can't deal with TX you can also set the
2019  *	%IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX flag to encrypt such frames in SW.
2020  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT: This flag should be set by the
2021  *	driver for a CCMP/GCMP key to indicate that is requires IV generation
2022  *	only for management frames (MFP).
2023  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM: This flag should be set by the
2024  *	driver for a key to indicate that sufficient tailroom must always
2025  *	be reserved for ICV or MIC, even when HW encryption is enabled.
2026  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver for
2027  *	a TKIP key if it only requires MIC space. Do not set together with
2028  *	@IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC on the same key.
2029  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_NO_AUTO_TX: Key needs explicit Tx activation.
2030  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIE: This flag should be set by the driver
2031  *	for a AES_CMAC key to indicate that it requires sequence number
2032  *	generation only
2033  */
2034 enum ieee80211_key_flags {
2035 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT	= BIT(0),
2036 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV		= BIT(1),
2037 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC	= BIT(2),
2038 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE		= BIT(3),
2039 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX		= BIT(4),
2040 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE		= BIT(5),
2041 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT		= BIT(6),
2042 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM	= BIT(7),
2043 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE	= BIT(8),
2044 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_NO_AUTO_TX		= BIT(9),
2045 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIE	= BIT(10),
2046 };
2047 
2048 /**
2049  * struct ieee80211_key_conf - key information
2050  *
2051  * This key information is given by mac80211 to the driver by
2052  * the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops.
2053  *
2054  * @hw_key_idx: To be set by the driver, this is the key index the driver
2055  *	wants to be given when a frame is transmitted and needs to be
2056  *	encrypted in hardware.
2057  * @cipher: The key's cipher suite selector.
2058  * @tx_pn: PN used for TX keys, may be used by the driver as well if it
2059  *	needs to do software PN assignment by itself (e.g. due to TSO)
2060  * @flags: key flags, see &enum ieee80211_key_flags.
2061  * @keyidx: the key index (0-3)
2062  * @keylen: key material length
2063  * @key: key material. For ALG_TKIP the key is encoded as a 256-bit (32 byte)
2064  * 	data block:
2065  * 	- Temporal Encryption Key (128 bits)
2066  * 	- Temporal Authenticator Tx MIC Key (64 bits)
2067  * 	- Temporal Authenticator Rx MIC Key (64 bits)
2068  * @icv_len: The ICV length for this key type
2069  * @iv_len: The IV length for this key type
2070  * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, or -1 for non-MLO or pairwise keys
2071  */
2072 struct ieee80211_key_conf {
2073 	atomic64_t tx_pn;
2074 	u32 cipher;
2075 	u8 icv_len;
2076 	u8 iv_len;
2077 	u8 hw_key_idx;
2078 	s8 keyidx;
2079 	u16 flags;
2080 	s8 link_id;
2081 	u8 keylen;
2082 	u8 key[];
2083 };
2084 
2085 #define IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN	16
2086 
2087 #define TKIP_PN_TO_IV16(pn) ((u16)(pn & 0xffff))
2088 #define TKIP_PN_TO_IV32(pn) ((u32)((pn >> 16) & 0xffffffff))
2089 
2090 /**
2091  * struct ieee80211_key_seq - key sequence counter
2092  *
2093  * @tkip: TKIP data, containing IV32 and IV16 in host byte order
2094  * @ccmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2095  *	reverse order than in packet)
2096  * @aes_cmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2097  *	reverse order than in packet)
2098  * @aes_gmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2099  *	reverse order than in packet)
2100  * @gcmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2101  *	reverse order than in packet)
2102  * @hw: data for HW-only (e.g. cipher scheme) keys
2103  */
2104 struct ieee80211_key_seq {
2105 	union {
2106 		struct {
2107 			u32 iv32;
2108 			u16 iv16;
2109 		} tkip;
2110 		struct {
2111 			u8 pn[6];
2112 		} ccmp;
2113 		struct {
2114 			u8 pn[6];
2115 		} aes_cmac;
2116 		struct {
2117 			u8 pn[6];
2118 		} aes_gmac;
2119 		struct {
2120 			u8 pn[6];
2121 		} gcmp;
2122 		struct {
2123 			u8 seq[IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN];
2124 			u8 seq_len;
2125 		} hw;
2126 	};
2127 };
2128 
2129 /**
2130  * enum set_key_cmd - key command
2131  *
2132  * Used with the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this
2133  * indicates whether a key is being removed or added.
2134  *
2135  * @SET_KEY: a key is set
2136  * @DISABLE_KEY: a key must be disabled
2137  */
2138 enum set_key_cmd {
2139 	SET_KEY, DISABLE_KEY,
2140 };
2141 
2142 /**
2143  * enum ieee80211_sta_state - station state
2144  *
2145  * @IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST: station doesn't exist at all,
2146  *	this is a special state for add/remove transitions
2147  * @IEEE80211_STA_NONE: station exists without special state
2148  * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTH: station is authenticated
2149  * @IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC: station is associated
2150  * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED: station is authorized (802.1X)
2151  */
2152 enum ieee80211_sta_state {
2153 	/* NOTE: These need to be ordered correctly! */
2154 	IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST,
2155 	IEEE80211_STA_NONE,
2156 	IEEE80211_STA_AUTH,
2157 	IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC,
2158 	IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED,
2159 };
2160 
2161 /**
2162  * enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth - station RX bandwidth
2163  * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20: station can only receive 20 MHz
2164  * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40: station can receive up to 40 MHz
2165  * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80: station can receive up to 80 MHz
2166  * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160: station can receive up to 160 MHz
2167  *	(including 80+80 MHz)
2168  * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320: station can receive up to 320 MHz
2169  *
2170  * Implementation note: 20 must be zero to be initialized
2171  *	correctly, the values must be sorted.
2172  */
2173 enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth {
2174 	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20 = 0,
2175 	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40,
2176 	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80,
2177 	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160,
2178 	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320,
2179 };
2180 
2181 /**
2182  * struct ieee80211_sta_rates - station rate selection table
2183  *
2184  * @rcu_head: RCU head used for freeing the table on update
2185  * @rate: transmit rates/flags to be used by default.
2186  *	Overriding entries per-packet is possible by using cb tx control.
2187  */
2188 struct ieee80211_sta_rates {
2189 	struct rcu_head rcu_head;
2190 	struct {
2191 		s8 idx;
2192 		u8 count;
2193 		u8 count_cts;
2194 		u8 count_rts;
2195 		u16 flags;
2196 	} rate[IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE];
2197 };
2198 
2199 /**
2200  * struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr - station txpower configuration
2201  *
2202  * Used to configure txpower for station.
2203  *
2204  * @power: indicates the tx power, in dBm, to be used when sending data frames
2205  *	to the STA.
2206  * @type: In particular if TPC %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED then tx power
2207  *	will be less than or equal to specified from userspace, whereas if TPC
2208  *	%type is NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC then it indicates default tx power.
2209  *	NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED is not a valid configuration option for
2210  *	per peer TPC.
2211  */
2212 struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr {
2213 	s16 power;
2214 	enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type;
2215 };
2216 
2217 /**
2218  * struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates - info that is aggregated from active links
2219  *
2220  * Used for any per-link data that needs to be aggregated and updated in the
2221  * main &struct ieee80211_sta when updated or the active links change.
2222  *
2223  * @max_amsdu_len: indicates the maximal length of an A-MSDU in bytes.
2224  *	This field is always valid for packets with a VHT preamble.
2225  *	For packets with a HT preamble, additional limits apply:
2226  *
2227  *	* If the skb is transmitted as part of a BA agreement, the
2228  *	  A-MSDU maximal size is min(max_amsdu_len, 4065) bytes.
2229  *	* If the skb is not part of a BA agreement, the A-MSDU maximal
2230  *	  size is min(max_amsdu_len, 7935) bytes.
2231  *
2232  * Both additional HT limits must be enforced by the low level
2233  * driver. This is defined by the spec (IEEE 802.11-2012 section
2234  * 8.3.2.2 NOTE 2).
2235  * @max_rc_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes recommended by rate control.
2236  * @max_tid_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes for this TID
2237  */
2238 struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates {
2239 	u16 max_amsdu_len;
2240 
2241 	u16 max_rc_amsdu_len;
2242 	u16 max_tid_amsdu_len[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS];
2243 };
2244 
2245 /**
2246  * struct ieee80211_link_sta - station Link specific info
2247  * All link specific info for a STA link for a non MLD STA(single)
2248  * or a MLD STA(multiple entries) are stored here.
2249  *
2250  * @sta: reference to owning STA
2251  * @addr: MAC address of the Link STA. For non-MLO STA this is same as the addr
2252  *	in ieee80211_sta. For MLO Link STA this addr can be same or different
2253  *	from addr in ieee80211_sta (representing MLD STA addr)
2254  * @link_id: the link ID for this link STA (0 for deflink)
2255  * @smps_mode: current SMPS mode (off, static or dynamic)
2256  * @supp_rates: Bitmap of supported rates
2257  * @ht_cap: HT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities
2258  * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities
2259  * @he_cap: HE capabilities of this STA
2260  * @he_6ghz_capa: on 6 GHz, holds the HE 6 GHz band capabilities
2261  * @eht_cap: EHT capabilities of this STA
2262  * @bandwidth: current bandwidth the station can receive with
2263  * @rx_nss: in HT/VHT, the maximum number of spatial streams the
2264  *	station can receive at the moment, changed by operating mode
2265  *	notifications and capabilities. The value is only valid after
2266  *	the station moves to associated state.
2267  * @txpwr: the station tx power configuration
2268  *
2269  */
2270 struct ieee80211_link_sta {
2271 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2272 
2273 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
2274 	u8 link_id;
2275 	enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
2276 
2277 	u32 supp_rates[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2278 	struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap ht_cap;
2279 	struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap vht_cap;
2280 	struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap he_cap;
2281 	struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa he_6ghz_capa;
2282 	struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap eht_cap;
2283 
2284 	struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates agg;
2285 
2286 	u8 rx_nss;
2287 	enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth bandwidth;
2288 	struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr txpwr;
2289 };
2290 
2291 /**
2292  * struct ieee80211_sta - station table entry
2293  *
2294  * A station table entry represents a station we are possibly
2295  * communicating with. Since stations are RCU-managed in
2296  * mac80211, any ieee80211_sta pointer you get access to must
2297  * either be protected by rcu_read_lock() explicitly or implicitly,
2298  * or you must take good care to not use such a pointer after a
2299  * call to your sta_remove callback that removed it.
2300  * This also represents the MLD STA in case of MLO association
2301  * and holds pointers to various link STA's
2302  *
2303  * @addr: MAC address
2304  * @aid: AID we assigned to the station if we're an AP
2305  * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximal amount of frames in a single AMPDU
2306  *	that this station is allowed to transmit to us.
2307  *	Can be modified by driver.
2308  * @wme: indicates whether the STA supports QoS/WME (if local devices does,
2309  *	otherwise always false)
2310  * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
2311  *	sizeof(void \*), size is determined in hw information.
2312  * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. Only valid
2313  *	if wme is supported. The bits order is like in
2314  *	IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_*.
2315  * @max_sp: max Service Period. Only valid if wme is supported.
2316  * @rates: rate control selection table
2317  * @tdls: indicates whether the STA is a TDLS peer
2318  * @tdls_initiator: indicates the STA is an initiator of the TDLS link. Only
2319  *	valid if the STA is a TDLS peer in the first place.
2320  * @mfp: indicates whether the STA uses management frame protection or not.
2321  * @mlo: indicates whether the STA is MLO station.
2322  * @max_amsdu_subframes: indicates the maximal number of MSDUs in a single
2323  *	A-MSDU. Taken from the Extended Capabilities element. 0 means
2324  *	unlimited.
2325  * @cur: currently valid data as aggregated from the active links
2326  *	For non MLO STA it will point to the deflink data. For MLO STA
2327  *	ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates() must be called to update it.
2328  * @support_p2p_ps: indicates whether the STA supports P2P PS mechanism or not.
2329  * @txq: per-TID data TX queues; note that the last entry (%IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS)
2330  *	is used for non-data frames
2331  * @deflink: This holds the default link STA information, for non MLO STA all link
2332  *	specific STA information is accessed through @deflink or through
2333  *	link[0] which points to address of @deflink. For MLO Link STA
2334  *	the first added link STA will point to deflink.
2335  * @link: reference to Link Sta entries. For Non MLO STA, except 1st link,
2336  *	i.e link[0] all links would be assigned to NULL by default and
2337  *	would access link information via @deflink or link[0]. For MLO
2338  *	STA, first link STA being added will point its link pointer to
2339  *	@deflink address and remaining would be allocated and the address
2340  *	would be assigned to link[link_id] where link_id is the id assigned
2341  *	by the AP.
2342  * @valid_links: bitmap of valid links, or 0 for non-MLO
2343  */
2344 struct ieee80211_sta {
2345 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
2346 	u16 aid;
2347 	u16 max_rx_aggregation_subframes;
2348 	bool wme;
2349 	u8 uapsd_queues;
2350 	u8 max_sp;
2351 	struct ieee80211_sta_rates __rcu *rates;
2352 	bool tdls;
2353 	bool tdls_initiator;
2354 	bool mfp;
2355 	bool mlo;
2356 	u8 max_amsdu_subframes;
2357 
2358 	struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates *cur;
2359 
2360 	bool support_p2p_ps;
2361 
2362 	struct ieee80211_txq *txq[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS + 1];
2363 
2364 	u16 valid_links;
2365 	struct ieee80211_link_sta deflink;
2366 	struct ieee80211_link_sta __rcu *link[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
2367 
2368 	/* must be last */
2369 	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2370 };
2371 
2372 #ifdef CONFIG_LOCKDEP
2373 bool lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
2374 #else
2375 static inline bool lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta)
2376 {
2377 	return true;
2378 }
2379 #endif
2380 
2381 #define link_sta_dereference_protected(sta, link_id)		\
2382 	rcu_dereference_protected((sta)->link[link_id],		\
2383 				  lockdep_sta_mutex_held(sta))
2384 
2385 #define link_sta_dereference_check(sta, link_id)		\
2386 	rcu_dereference_check((sta)->link[link_id],		\
2387 			      lockdep_sta_mutex_held(sta))
2388 
2389 #define for_each_sta_active_link(vif, sta, link_sta, link_id)			\
2390 	for (link_id = 0; link_id < ARRAY_SIZE((sta)->link); link_id++)		\
2391 		if ((!(vif)->active_links ||					\
2392 		     (vif)->active_links & BIT(link_id)) &&			\
2393 		    ((link_sta) = link_sta_dereference_protected(sta, link_id)))
2394 
2395 /**
2396  * enum sta_notify_cmd - sta notify command
2397  *
2398  * Used with the sta_notify() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this
2399  * indicates if an associated station made a power state transition.
2400  *
2401  * @STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP: a station is now sleeping
2402  * @STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE: a sleeping station woke up
2403  */
2404 enum sta_notify_cmd {
2405 	STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP, STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE,
2406 };
2407 
2408 /**
2409  * struct ieee80211_tx_control - TX control data
2410  *
2411  * @sta: station table entry, this sta pointer may be NULL and
2412  * 	it is not allowed to copy the pointer, due to RCU.
2413  */
2414 struct ieee80211_tx_control {
2415 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2416 };
2417 
2418 /**
2419  * struct ieee80211_txq - Software intermediate tx queue
2420  *
2421  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
2422  * @sta: station table entry, %NULL for per-vif queue
2423  * @tid: the TID for this queue (unused for per-vif queue),
2424  *	%IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS for non-data (if enabled)
2425  * @ac: the AC for this queue
2426  * @drv_priv: driver private area, sized by hw->txq_data_size
2427  *
2428  * The driver can obtain packets from this queue by calling
2429  * ieee80211_tx_dequeue().
2430  */
2431 struct ieee80211_txq {
2432 	struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
2433 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2434 	u8 tid;
2435 	u8 ac;
2436 
2437 	/* must be last */
2438 	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2439 };
2440 
2441 /**
2442  * enum ieee80211_hw_flags - hardware flags
2443  *
2444  * These flags are used to indicate hardware capabilities to
2445  * the stack. Generally, flags here should have their meaning
2446  * done in a way that the simplest hardware doesn't need setting
2447  * any particular flags. There are some exceptions to this rule,
2448  * however, so you are advised to review these flags carefully.
2449  *
2450  * @IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL:
2451  *	The hardware or firmware includes rate control, and cannot be
2452  *	controlled by the stack. As such, no rate control algorithm
2453  *	should be instantiated, and the TX rate reported to userspace
2454  *	will be taken from the TX status instead of the rate control
2455  *	algorithm.
2456  *	Note that this requires that the driver implement a number of
2457  *	callbacks so it has the correct information, it needs to have
2458  *	the @set_rts_threshold callback and must look at the BSS config
2459  *	@use_cts_prot for G/N protection, @use_short_slot for slot
2460  *	timing in 2.4 GHz and @use_short_preamble for preambles for
2461  *	CCK frames.
2462  *
2463  * @IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS:
2464  *	Indicates that received frames passed to the stack include
2465  *	the FCS at the end.
2466  *
2467  * @IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING:
2468  *	Some wireless LAN chipsets buffer broadcast/multicast frames
2469  *	for power saving stations in the hardware/firmware and others
2470  *	rely on the host system for such buffering. This option is used
2471  *	to configure the IEEE 802.11 upper layer to buffer broadcast and
2472  *	multicast frames when there are power saving stations so that
2473  *	the driver can fetch them with ieee80211_get_buffered_bc().
2474  *
2475  * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC:
2476  *	Hardware can provide signal values but we don't know its units. We
2477  *	expect values between 0 and @max_signal.
2478  *	If possible please provide dB or dBm instead.
2479  *
2480  * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM:
2481  *	Hardware gives signal values in dBm, decibel difference from
2482  *	one milliwatt. This is the preferred method since it is standardized
2483  *	between different devices. @max_signal does not need to be set.
2484  *
2485  * @IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT:
2486  * 	Hardware supports spectrum management defined in 802.11h
2487  * 	Measurement, Channel Switch, Quieting, TPC
2488  *
2489  * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION:
2490  *	Hardware supports 11n A-MPDU aggregation.
2491  *
2492  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS:
2493  *	Hardware has power save support (i.e. can go to sleep).
2494  *
2495  * @IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK:
2496  *	Hardware requires nullfunc frame handling in stack, implies
2497  *	stack support for dynamic PS.
2498  *
2499  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS:
2500  *	Hardware has support for dynamic PS.
2501  *
2502  * @IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE:
2503  *	Hardware supports management frame protection (MFP, IEEE 802.11w).
2504  *
2505  * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS:
2506  *	Hardware can provide ack status reports of Tx frames to
2507  *	the stack.
2508  *
2509  * @IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR:
2510  *	The hardware performs its own connection monitoring, including
2511  *	periodic keep-alives to the AP and probing the AP on beacon loss.
2512  *
2513  * @IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC:
2514  *	This device needs to get data from beacon before association (i.e.
2515  *	dtim_period).
2516  *
2517  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK: The device's crypto engine supports
2518  *	per-station GTKs as used by IBSS RSN or during fast transition. If
2519  *	the device doesn't support per-station GTKs, but can be asked not
2520  *	to decrypt group addressed frames, then IBSS RSN support is still
2521  *	possible but software crypto will be used. Advertise the wiphy flag
2522  *	only in that case.
2523  *
2524  * @IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS: When operating in AP mode the device
2525  *	autonomously manages the PS status of connected stations. When
2526  *	this flag is set mac80211 will not trigger PS mode for connected
2527  *	stations based on the PM bit of incoming frames.
2528  *	Use ieee80211_start_ps()/ieee8021_end_ps() to manually configure
2529  *	the PS mode of connected stations.
2530  *
2531  * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW: The device handles TX A-MPDU session
2532  *	setup strictly in HW. mac80211 should not attempt to do this in
2533  *	software.
2534  *
2535  * @IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF: The driver would like to be informed of
2536  *	a virtual monitor interface when monitor interfaces are the only
2537  *	active interfaces.
2538  *
2539  * @IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF: The driver would like for no wlanX to
2540  *	be created.  It is expected user-space will create vifs as
2541  *	desired (and thus have them named as desired).
2542  *
2543  * @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL: The driver wants to control which of the
2544  *	crypto algorithms can be done in software - so don't automatically
2545  *	try to fall back to it if hardware crypto fails, but do so only if
2546  *	the driver returns 1. This also forces the driver to advertise its
2547  *	supported cipher suites.
2548  *
2549  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT: The driver/hardware supports fast-xmit,
2550  *	this currently requires only the ability to calculate the duration
2551  *	for frames.
2552  *
2553  * @IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL: The driver wants to control per-interface
2554  *	queue mapping in order to use different queues (not just one per AC)
2555  *	for different virtual interfaces. See the doc section on HW queue
2556  *	control for more details.
2557  *
2558  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE: The driver supports using a rate
2559  *	selection table provided by the rate control algorithm.
2560  *
2561  * @IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF: Use the P2P Device address for any
2562  *	P2P Interface. This will be honoured even if more than one interface
2563  *	is supported.
2564  *
2565  * @IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY: Use sync timing from beacon frames
2566  *	only, to allow getting TBTT of a DTIM beacon.
2567  *
2568  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES: Hardware supports mixing HT/CCK rates
2569  *	and can cope with CCK rates in an aggregation session (e.g. by not
2570  *	using aggregation for such frames.)
2571  *
2572  * @IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA: Support 802.11h based channel-switch (CSA)
2573  *	for a single active channel while using channel contexts. When support
2574  *	is not enabled the default action is to disconnect when getting the
2575  *	CSA frame.
2576  *
2577  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS: The driver will never modify the payload
2578  *	or tailroom of TX skbs without copying them first.
2579  *
2580  * @IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS: The HW supports scanning on all bands
2581  *	in one command, mac80211 doesn't have to run separate scans per band.
2582  *
2583  * @IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW: The device/driver supports wider bandwidth
2584  *	than then BSS bandwidth for a TDLS link on the base channel.
2585  *
2586  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU: The driver supports receiving A-MSDUs
2587  *	within A-MPDU.
2588  *
2589  * @IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS: The device/driver provides TX status
2590  *	for sent beacons.
2591  *
2592  * @IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR: Hardware (or driver) requires that each
2593  *	station has a unique address, i.e. each station entry can be identified
2594  *	by just its MAC address; this prevents, for example, the same station
2595  *	from connecting to two virtual AP interfaces at the same time.
2596  *
2597  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER: Hardware (or driver) manages the
2598  *	reordering buffer internally, guaranteeing mac80211 receives frames in
2599  *	order and does not need to manage its own reorder buffer or BA session
2600  *	timeout.
2601  *
2602  * @IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS: The device uses RSS and thus requires parallel RX,
2603  *	which implies using per-CPU station statistics.
2604  *
2605  * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU: Hardware (or driver) supports software aggregated
2606  *	A-MSDU frames. Requires software tx queueing and fast-xmit support.
2607  *	When not using minstrel/minstrel_ht rate control, the driver must
2608  *	limit the maximum A-MSDU size based on the current tx rate by setting
2609  *	max_rc_amsdu_len in struct ieee80211_sta.
2610  *
2611  * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST: Hardware (or driver) supports sending frag_list
2612  *	skbs, needed for zero-copy software A-MSDU.
2613  *
2614  * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK: The driver (or firmware) reports low ack event
2615  *	by ieee80211_report_low_ack() based on its own algorithm. For such
2616  *	drivers, mac80211 packet loss mechanism will not be triggered and driver
2617  *	is completely depending on firmware event for station kickout.
2618  *
2619  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG: Hardware does fragmentation by itself.
2620  *	The stack will not do fragmentation.
2621  *	The callback for @set_frag_threshold should be set as well.
2622  *
2623  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA: Hardware supports buffer STA on
2624  *	TDLS links.
2625  *
2626  * @IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP: The driver requires the
2627  *	mgd_prepare_tx() callback to be called before transmission of a
2628  *	deauthentication frame in case the association was completed but no
2629  *	beacon was heard. This is required in multi-channel scenarios, where the
2630  *	virtual interface might not be given air time for the transmission of
2631  *	the frame, as it is not synced with the AP/P2P GO yet, and thus the
2632  *	deauthentication frame might not be transmitted.
2633  *
2634  * @IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP: The driver (or firmware) doesn't
2635  *	support QoS NDP for AP probing - that's most likely a driver bug.
2636  *
2637  * @IEEE80211_HW_BUFF_MMPDU_TXQ: use the TXQ for bufferable MMPDUs, this of
2638  *	course requires the driver to use TXQs to start with.
2639  *
2640  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW: (Hardware) rate control supports VHT
2641  *	extended NSS BW (dot11VHTExtendedNSSBWCapable). This flag will be set if
2642  *	the selected rate control algorithm sets %RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW
2643  *	but if the rate control is built-in then it must be set by the driver.
2644  *	See also the documentation for that flag.
2645  *
2646  * @IEEE80211_HW_STA_MMPDU_TXQ: use the extra non-TID per-station TXQ for all
2647  *	MMPDUs on station interfaces. This of course requires the driver to use
2648  *	TXQs to start with.
2649  *
2650  * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_STATUS_NO_AMPDU_LEN: Driver does not report accurate A-MPDU
2651  *	length in tx status information
2652  *
2653  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID: Hardware supports multi BSSID
2654  *
2655  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_ONLY_HE_MULTI_BSSID: Hardware supports multi BSSID
2656  *	only for HE APs. Applies if @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID is set.
2657  *
2658  * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_KEYBORDER_SUPPORT: The card and driver is only
2659  *	aggregating MPDUs with the same keyid, allowing mac80211 to keep Tx
2660  *	A-MPDU sessions active while rekeying with Extended Key ID.
2661  *
2662  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_ENCAP_OFFLOAD: Hardware supports tx encapsulation
2663  *	offload
2664  *
2665  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RX_DECAP_OFFLOAD: Hardware supports rx decapsulation
2666  *	offload
2667  *
2668  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CONC_MON_RX_DECAP: Hardware supports concurrent rx
2669  *	decapsulation offload and passing raw 802.11 frames for monitor iface.
2670  *	If this is supported, the driver must pass both 802.3 frames for real
2671  *	usage and 802.11 frames with %RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR set for monitor to
2672  *	the stack.
2673  *
2674  * @IEEE80211_HW_DETECTS_COLOR_COLLISION: HW/driver has support for BSS color
2675  *	collision detection and doesn't need it in software.
2676  *
2677  * @IEEE80211_HW_MLO_MCAST_MULTI_LINK_TX: Hardware/driver handles transmitting
2678  *	multicast frames on all links, mac80211 should not do that.
2679  *
2680  * @NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS: number of hardware flags, used for sizing arrays
2681  */
2682 enum ieee80211_hw_flags {
2683 	IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL,
2684 	IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS,
2685 	IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING,
2686 	IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC,
2687 	IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM,
2688 	IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC,
2689 	IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT,
2690 	IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION,
2691 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS,
2692 	IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK,
2693 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS,
2694 	IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE,
2695 	IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF,
2696 	IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF,
2697 	IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL,
2698 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT,
2699 	IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS,
2700 	IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR,
2701 	IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL,
2702 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK,
2703 	IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS,
2704 	IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW,
2705 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE,
2706 	IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF,
2707 	IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY,
2708 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES,
2709 	IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA,
2710 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS,
2711 	IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS,
2712 	IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW,
2713 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU,
2714 	IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS,
2715 	IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR,
2716 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER,
2717 	IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS,
2718 	IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU,
2719 	IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST,
2720 	IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK,
2721 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG,
2722 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA,
2723 	IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP,
2724 	IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP,
2725 	IEEE80211_HW_BUFF_MMPDU_TXQ,
2726 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW,
2727 	IEEE80211_HW_STA_MMPDU_TXQ,
2728 	IEEE80211_HW_TX_STATUS_NO_AMPDU_LEN,
2729 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID,
2730 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_ONLY_HE_MULTI_BSSID,
2731 	IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_KEYBORDER_SUPPORT,
2732 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_ENCAP_OFFLOAD,
2733 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RX_DECAP_OFFLOAD,
2734 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CONC_MON_RX_DECAP,
2735 	IEEE80211_HW_DETECTS_COLOR_COLLISION,
2736 	IEEE80211_HW_MLO_MCAST_MULTI_LINK_TX,
2737 
2738 	/* keep last, obviously */
2739 	NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS
2740 };
2741 
2742 /**
2743  * struct ieee80211_hw - hardware information and state
2744  *
2745  * This structure contains the configuration and hardware
2746  * information for an 802.11 PHY.
2747  *
2748  * @wiphy: This points to the &struct wiphy allocated for this
2749  *	802.11 PHY. You must fill in the @perm_addr and @dev
2750  *	members of this structure using SET_IEEE80211_DEV()
2751  *	and SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(). Additionally, all supported
2752  *	bands (with channels, bitrates) are registered here.
2753  *
2754  * @conf: &struct ieee80211_conf, device configuration, don't use.
2755  *
2756  * @priv: pointer to private area that was allocated for driver use
2757  *	along with this structure.
2758  *
2759  * @flags: hardware flags, see &enum ieee80211_hw_flags.
2760  *
2761  * @extra_tx_headroom: headroom to reserve in each transmit skb
2762  *	for use by the driver (e.g. for transmit headers.)
2763  *
2764  * @extra_beacon_tailroom: tailroom to reserve in each beacon tx skb.
2765  *	Can be used by drivers to add extra IEs.
2766  *
2767  * @max_signal: Maximum value for signal (rssi) in RX information, used
2768  *	only when @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC or @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DB
2769  *
2770  * @max_listen_interval: max listen interval in units of beacon interval
2771  *	that HW supports
2772  *
2773  * @queues: number of available hardware transmit queues for
2774  *	data packets. WMM/QoS requires at least four, these
2775  *	queues need to have configurable access parameters.
2776  *
2777  * @rate_control_algorithm: rate control algorithm for this hardware.
2778  *	If unset (NULL), the default algorithm will be used. Must be
2779  *	set before calling ieee80211_register_hw().
2780  *
2781  * @vif_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2782  *	within &struct ieee80211_vif.
2783  * @sta_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2784  *	within &struct ieee80211_sta.
2785  * @chanctx_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2786  *	within &struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf.
2787  * @txq_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2788  *	within @struct ieee80211_txq.
2789  *
2790  * @max_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages the hw
2791  *	can handle.
2792  * @max_report_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages
2793  *	the hw can report back.
2794  * @max_rate_tries: maximum number of tries for each stage
2795  *
2796  * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximum buffer size (number of
2797  *	sub-frames) to be used for A-MPDU block ack receiver
2798  *	aggregation.
2799  *	This is only relevant if the device has restrictions on the
2800  *	number of subframes, if it relies on mac80211 to do reordering
2801  *	it shouldn't be set.
2802  *
2803  * @max_tx_aggregation_subframes: maximum number of subframes in an
2804  *	aggregate an HT/HE device will transmit. In HT AddBA we'll
2805  *	advertise a constant value of 64 as some older APs crash if
2806  *	the window size is smaller (an example is LinkSys WRT120N
2807  *	with FW v1.0.07 build 002 Jun 18 2012).
2808  *	For AddBA to HE capable peers this value will be used.
2809  *
2810  * @max_tx_fragments: maximum number of tx buffers per (A)-MSDU, sum
2811  *	of 1 + skb_shinfo(skb)->nr_frags for each skb in the frag_list.
2812  *
2813  * @offchannel_tx_hw_queue: HW queue ID to use for offchannel TX
2814  *	(if %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL is set)
2815  *
2816  * @radiotap_mcs_details: lists which MCS information can the HW
2817  *	reports, by default it is set to _MCS, _GI and _BW but doesn't
2818  *	include _FMT. Use %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_\* values, only
2819  *	adding _BW is supported today.
2820  *
2821  * @radiotap_vht_details: lists which VHT MCS information the HW reports,
2822  *	the default is _GI | _BANDWIDTH.
2823  *	Use the %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_VHT_KNOWN_\* values.
2824  *
2825  * @radiotap_he: HE radiotap validity flags
2826  *
2827  * @radiotap_timestamp: Information for the radiotap timestamp field; if the
2828  *	@units_pos member is set to a non-negative value then the timestamp
2829  *	field will be added and populated from the &struct ieee80211_rx_status
2830  *	device_timestamp.
2831  * @radiotap_timestamp.units_pos: Must be set to a combination of a
2832  *	IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_UNIT_* and a
2833  *	IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_SPOS_* value.
2834  * @radiotap_timestamp.accuracy: If non-negative, fills the accuracy in the
2835  *	radiotap field and the accuracy known flag will be set.
2836  *
2837  * @netdev_features: netdev features to be set in each netdev created
2838  *	from this HW. Note that not all features are usable with mac80211,
2839  *	other features will be rejected during HW registration.
2840  *
2841  * @uapsd_queues: This bitmap is included in (re)association frame to indicate
2842  *	for each access category if it is uAPSD trigger-enabled and delivery-
2843  *	enabled. Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_* to set this bitmap.
2844  *	Each bit corresponds to different AC. Value '1' in specific bit means
2845  *	that corresponding AC is both trigger- and delivery-enabled. '0' means
2846  *	neither enabled.
2847  *
2848  * @uapsd_max_sp_len: maximum number of total buffered frames the WMM AP may
2849  *	deliver to a WMM STA during any Service Period triggered by the WMM STA.
2850  *	Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_SP_* for correct values.
2851  *
2852  * @max_nan_de_entries: maximum number of NAN DE functions supported by the
2853  *	device.
2854  *
2855  * @tx_sk_pacing_shift: Pacing shift to set on TCP sockets when frames from
2856  *	them are encountered. The default should typically not be changed,
2857  *	unless the driver has good reasons for needing more buffers.
2858  *
2859  * @weight_multiplier: Driver specific airtime weight multiplier used while
2860  *	refilling deficit of each TXQ.
2861  *
2862  * @max_mtu: the max mtu could be set.
2863  *
2864  * @tx_power_levels: a list of power levels supported by the wifi hardware.
2865  * 	The power levels can be specified either as integer or fractions.
2866  * 	The power level at idx 0 shall be the maximum positive power level.
2867  *
2868  * @max_txpwr_levels_idx: the maximum valid idx of 'tx_power_levels' list.
2869  */
2870 struct ieee80211_hw {
2871 	struct ieee80211_conf conf;
2872 	struct wiphy *wiphy;
2873 	const char *rate_control_algorithm;
2874 	void *priv;
2875 	unsigned long flags[BITS_TO_LONGS(NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS)];
2876 	unsigned int extra_tx_headroom;
2877 	unsigned int extra_beacon_tailroom;
2878 	int vif_data_size;
2879 	int sta_data_size;
2880 	int chanctx_data_size;
2881 	int txq_data_size;
2882 	u16 queues;
2883 	u16 max_listen_interval;
2884 	s8 max_signal;
2885 	u8 max_rates;
2886 	u8 max_report_rates;
2887 	u8 max_rate_tries;
2888 	u16 max_rx_aggregation_subframes;
2889 	u16 max_tx_aggregation_subframes;
2890 	u8 max_tx_fragments;
2891 	u8 offchannel_tx_hw_queue;
2892 	u8 radiotap_mcs_details;
2893 	u16 radiotap_vht_details;
2894 	struct {
2895 		int units_pos;
2896 		s16 accuracy;
2897 	} radiotap_timestamp;
2898 	netdev_features_t netdev_features;
2899 	u8 uapsd_queues;
2900 	u8 uapsd_max_sp_len;
2901 	u8 max_nan_de_entries;
2902 	u8 tx_sk_pacing_shift;
2903 	u8 weight_multiplier;
2904 	u32 max_mtu;
2905 	const s8 *tx_power_levels;
2906 	u8 max_txpwr_levels_idx;
2907 };
2908 
2909 static inline bool _ieee80211_hw_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2910 				       enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)
2911 {
2912 	return test_bit(flg, hw->flags);
2913 }
2914 #define ieee80211_hw_check(hw, flg)	_ieee80211_hw_check(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg)
2915 
2916 static inline void _ieee80211_hw_set(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2917 				     enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)
2918 {
2919 	return __set_bit(flg, hw->flags);
2920 }
2921 #define ieee80211_hw_set(hw, flg)	_ieee80211_hw_set(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg)
2922 
2923 /**
2924  * struct ieee80211_scan_request - hw scan request
2925  *
2926  * @ies: pointers different parts of IEs (in req.ie)
2927  * @req: cfg80211 request.
2928  */
2929 struct ieee80211_scan_request {
2930 	struct ieee80211_scan_ies ies;
2931 
2932 	/* Keep last */
2933 	struct cfg80211_scan_request req;
2934 };
2935 
2936 /**
2937  * struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params - TDLS channel switch parameters
2938  *
2939  * @sta: peer this TDLS channel-switch request/response came from
2940  * @chandef: channel referenced in a TDLS channel-switch request
2941  * @action_code: see &enum ieee80211_tdls_actioncode
2942  * @status: channel-switch response status
2943  * @timestamp: time at which the frame was received
2944  * @switch_time: switch-timing parameter received in the frame
2945  * @switch_timeout: switch-timing parameter received in the frame
2946  * @tmpl_skb: TDLS switch-channel response template
2947  * @ch_sw_tm_ie: offset of the channel-switch timing IE inside @tmpl_skb
2948  */
2949 struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params {
2950 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2951 	struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef;
2952 	u8 action_code;
2953 	u32 status;
2954 	u32 timestamp;
2955 	u16 switch_time;
2956 	u16 switch_timeout;
2957 	struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb;
2958 	u32 ch_sw_tm_ie;
2959 };
2960 
2961 /**
2962  * wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw - return a mac80211 driver hw struct from a wiphy
2963  *
2964  * @wiphy: the &struct wiphy which we want to query
2965  *
2966  * mac80211 drivers can use this to get to their respective
2967  * &struct ieee80211_hw. Drivers wishing to get to their own private
2968  * structure can then access it via hw->priv. Note that mac802111 drivers should
2969  * not use wiphy_priv() to try to get their private driver structure as this
2970  * is already used internally by mac80211.
2971  *
2972  * Return: The mac80211 driver hw struct of @wiphy.
2973  */
2974 struct ieee80211_hw *wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw(struct wiphy *wiphy);
2975 
2976 /**
2977  * SET_IEEE80211_DEV - set device for 802.11 hardware
2978  *
2979  * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the device for
2980  * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device
2981  */
2982 static inline void SET_IEEE80211_DEV(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct device *dev)
2983 {
2984 	set_wiphy_dev(hw->wiphy, dev);
2985 }
2986 
2987 /**
2988  * SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR - set the permanent MAC address for 802.11 hardware
2989  *
2990  * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the MAC address for
2991  * @addr: the address to set
2992  */
2993 static inline void SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, const u8 *addr)
2994 {
2995 	memcpy(hw->wiphy->perm_addr, addr, ETH_ALEN);
2996 }
2997 
2998 static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
2999 ieee80211_get_tx_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3000 		      const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c)
3001 {
3002 	if (WARN_ON_ONCE(c->control.rates[0].idx < 0))
3003 		return NULL;
3004 	return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[0].idx];
3005 }
3006 
3007 static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
3008 ieee80211_get_rts_cts_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3009 			   const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c)
3010 {
3011 	if (c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx < 0)
3012 		return NULL;
3013 	return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx];
3014 }
3015 
3016 static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
3017 ieee80211_get_alt_retry_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3018 			     const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c, int idx)
3019 {
3020 	if (c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx < 0)
3021 		return NULL;
3022 	return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx];
3023 }
3024 
3025 /**
3026  * ieee80211_free_txskb - free TX skb
3027  * @hw: the hardware
3028  * @skb: the skb
3029  *
3030  * Free a transmit skb. Use this function when some failure
3031  * to transmit happened and thus status cannot be reported.
3032  */
3033 void ieee80211_free_txskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb);
3034 
3035 /**
3036  * DOC: Hardware crypto acceleration
3037  *
3038  * mac80211 is capable of taking advantage of many hardware
3039  * acceleration designs for encryption and decryption operations.
3040  *
3041  * The set_key() callback in the &struct ieee80211_ops for a given
3042  * device is called to enable hardware acceleration of encryption and
3043  * decryption. The callback takes a @sta parameter that will be NULL
3044  * for default keys or keys used for transmission only, or point to
3045  * the station information for the peer for individual keys.
3046  * Multiple transmission keys with the same key index may be used when
3047  * VLANs are configured for an access point.
3048  *
3049  * When transmitting, the TX control data will use the @hw_key_idx
3050  * selected by the driver by modifying the &struct ieee80211_key_conf
3051  * pointed to by the @key parameter to the set_key() function.
3052  *
3053  * The set_key() call for the %SET_KEY command should return 0 if
3054  * the key is now in use, -%EOPNOTSUPP or -%ENOSPC if it couldn't be
3055  * added; if you return 0 then hw_key_idx must be assigned to the
3056  * hardware key index, you are free to use the full u8 range.
3057  *
3058  * Note that in the case that the @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL flag is
3059  * set, mac80211 will not automatically fall back to software crypto if
3060  * enabling hardware crypto failed. The set_key() call may also return the
3061  * value 1 to permit this specific key/algorithm to be done in software.
3062  *
3063  * When the cmd is %DISABLE_KEY then it must succeed.
3064  *
3065  * Note that it is permissible to not decrypt a frame even if a key
3066  * for it has been uploaded to hardware, the stack will not make any
3067  * decision based on whether a key has been uploaded or not but rather
3068  * based on the receive flags.
3069  *
3070  * The &struct ieee80211_key_conf structure pointed to by the @key
3071  * parameter is guaranteed to be valid until another call to set_key()
3072  * removes it, but it can only be used as a cookie to differentiate
3073  * keys.
3074  *
3075  * In TKIP some HW need to be provided a phase 1 key, for RX decryption
3076  * acceleration (i.e. iwlwifi). Those drivers should provide update_tkip_key
3077  * handler.
3078  * The update_tkip_key() call updates the driver with the new phase 1 key.
3079  * This happens every time the iv16 wraps around (every 65536 packets). The
3080  * set_key() call will happen only once for each key (unless the AP did
3081  * rekeying), it will not include a valid phase 1 key. The valid phase 1 key is
3082  * provided by update_tkip_key only. The trigger that makes mac80211 call this
3083  * handler is software decryption with wrap around of iv16.
3084  *
3085  * The set_default_unicast_key() call updates the default WEP key index
3086  * configured to the hardware for WEP encryption type. This is required
3087  * for devices that support offload of data packets (e.g. ARP responses).
3088  *
3089  * Mac80211 drivers should set the @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CAN_REPLACE_PTK0 flag
3090  * when they are able to replace in-use PTK keys according to the following
3091  * requirements:
3092  * 1) They do not hand over frames decrypted with the old key to mac80211
3093       once the call to set_key() with command %DISABLE_KEY has been completed,
3094    2) either drop or continue to use the old key for any outgoing frames queued
3095       at the time of the key deletion (including re-transmits),
3096    3) never send out a frame queued prior to the set_key() %SET_KEY command
3097       encrypted with the new key when also needing
3098       @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV and
3099    4) never send out a frame unencrypted when it should be encrypted.
3100    Mac80211 will not queue any new frames for a deleted key to the driver.
3101  */
3102 
3103 /**
3104  * DOC: Powersave support
3105  *
3106  * mac80211 has support for various powersave implementations.
3107  *
3108  * First, it can support hardware that handles all powersaving by itself,
3109  * such hardware should simply set the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS hardware
3110  * flag. In that case, it will be told about the desired powersave mode
3111  * with the %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag depending on the association status.
3112  * The hardware must take care of sending nullfunc frames when necessary,
3113  * i.e. when entering and leaving powersave mode. The hardware is required
3114  * to look at the AID in beacons and signal to the AP that it woke up when
3115  * it finds traffic directed to it.
3116  *
3117  * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag enabled means that the powersave mode defined in
3118  * IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2 is enabled. This is not to be confused
3119  * with hardware wakeup and sleep states. Driver is responsible for waking
3120  * up the hardware before issuing commands to the hardware and putting it
3121  * back to sleep at appropriate times.
3122  *
3123  * When PS is enabled, hardware needs to wakeup for beacons and receive the
3124  * buffered multicast/broadcast frames after the beacon. Also it must be
3125  * possible to send frames and receive the acknowledment frame.
3126  *
3127  * Other hardware designs cannot send nullfunc frames by themselves and also
3128  * need software support for parsing the TIM bitmap. This is also supported
3129  * by mac80211 by combining the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS and
3130  * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK flags. The hardware is of course still
3131  * required to pass up beacons. The hardware is still required to handle
3132  * waking up for multicast traffic; if it cannot the driver must handle that
3133  * as best as it can, mac80211 is too slow to do that.
3134  *
3135  * Dynamic powersave is an extension to normal powersave in which the
3136  * hardware stays awake for a user-specified period of time after sending a
3137  * frame so that reply frames need not be buffered and therefore delayed to
3138  * the next wakeup. It's compromise of getting good enough latency when
3139  * there's data traffic and still saving significantly power in idle
3140  * periods.
3141  *
3142  * Dynamic powersave is simply supported by mac80211 enabling and disabling
3143  * PS based on traffic. Driver needs to only set %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS
3144  * flag and mac80211 will handle everything automatically. Additionally,
3145  * hardware having support for the dynamic PS feature may set the
3146  * %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS flag to indicate that it can support
3147  * dynamic PS mode itself. The driver needs to look at the
3148  * @dynamic_ps_timeout hardware configuration value and use it that value
3149  * whenever %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. In this case mac80211 will disable
3150  * dynamic PS feature in stack and will just keep %IEEE80211_CONF_PS
3151  * enabled whenever user has enabled powersave.
3152  *
3153  * Driver informs U-APSD client support by enabling
3154  * %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD flag. The mode is configured through the
3155  * uapsd parameter in conf_tx() operation. Hardware needs to send the QoS
3156  * Nullfunc frames and stay awake until the service period has ended. To
3157  * utilize U-APSD, dynamic powersave is disabled for voip AC and all frames
3158  * from that AC are transmitted with powersave enabled.
3159  *
3160  * Note: U-APSD client mode is not yet supported with
3161  * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK.
3162  */
3163 
3164 /**
3165  * DOC: Beacon filter support
3166  *
3167  * Some hardware have beacon filter support to reduce host cpu wakeups
3168  * which will reduce system power consumption. It usually works so that
3169  * the firmware creates a checksum of the beacon but omits all constantly
3170  * changing elements (TSF, TIM etc). Whenever the checksum changes the
3171  * beacon is forwarded to the host, otherwise it will be just dropped. That
3172  * way the host will only receive beacons where some relevant information
3173  * (for example ERP protection or WMM settings) have changed.
3174  *
3175  * Beacon filter support is advertised with the %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER
3176  * interface capability. The driver needs to enable beacon filter support
3177  * whenever power save is enabled, that is %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. When
3178  * power save is enabled, the stack will not check for beacon loss and the
3179  * driver needs to notify about loss of beacons with ieee80211_beacon_loss().
3180  *
3181  * The time (or number of beacons missed) until the firmware notifies the
3182  * driver of a beacon loss event (which in turn causes the driver to call
3183  * ieee80211_beacon_loss()) should be configurable and will be controlled
3184  * by mac80211 and the roaming algorithm in the future.
3185  *
3186  * Since there may be constantly changing information elements that nothing
3187  * in the software stack cares about, we will, in the future, have mac80211
3188  * tell the driver which information elements are interesting in the sense
3189  * that we want to see changes in them. This will include
3190  *
3191  *  - a list of information element IDs
3192  *  - a list of OUIs for the vendor information element
3193  *
3194  * Ideally, the hardware would filter out any beacons without changes in the
3195  * requested elements, but if it cannot support that it may, at the expense
3196  * of some efficiency, filter out only a subset. For example, if the device
3197  * doesn't support checking for OUIs it should pass up all changes in all
3198  * vendor information elements.
3199  *
3200  * Note that change, for the sake of simplification, also includes information
3201  * elements appearing or disappearing from the beacon.
3202  *
3203  * Some hardware supports an "ignore list" instead, just make sure nothing
3204  * that was requested is on the ignore list, and include commonly changing
3205  * information element IDs in the ignore list, for example 11 (BSS load) and
3206  * the various vendor-assigned IEs with unknown contents (128, 129, 133-136,
3207  * 149, 150, 155, 156, 173, 176, 178, 179, 219); for forward compatibility
3208  * it could also include some currently unused IDs.
3209  *
3210  *
3211  * In addition to these capabilities, hardware should support notifying the
3212  * host of changes in the beacon RSSI. This is relevant to implement roaming
3213  * when no traffic is flowing (when traffic is flowing we see the RSSI of
3214  * the received data packets). This can consist in notifying the host when
3215  * the RSSI changes significantly or when it drops below or rises above
3216  * configurable thresholds. In the future these thresholds will also be
3217  * configured by mac80211 (which gets them from userspace) to implement
3218  * them as the roaming algorithm requires.
3219  *
3220  * If the hardware cannot implement this, the driver should ask it to
3221  * periodically pass beacon frames to the host so that software can do the
3222  * signal strength threshold checking.
3223  */
3224 
3225 /**
3226  * DOC: Spatial multiplexing power save
3227  *
3228  * SMPS (Spatial multiplexing power save) is a mechanism to conserve
3229  * power in an 802.11n implementation. For details on the mechanism
3230  * and rationale, please refer to 802.11 (as amended by 802.11n-2009)
3231  * "11.2.3 SM power save".
3232  *
3233  * The mac80211 implementation is capable of sending action frames
3234  * to update the AP about the station's SMPS mode, and will instruct
3235  * the driver to enter the specific mode. It will also announce the
3236  * requested SMPS mode during the association handshake. Hardware
3237  * support for this feature is required, and can be indicated by
3238  * hardware flags.
3239  *
3240  * The default mode will be "automatic", which nl80211/cfg80211
3241  * defines to be dynamic SMPS in (regular) powersave, and SMPS
3242  * turned off otherwise.
3243  *
3244  * To support this feature, the driver must set the appropriate
3245  * hardware support flags, and handle the SMPS flag to the config()
3246  * operation. It will then with this mechanism be instructed to
3247  * enter the requested SMPS mode while associated to an HT AP.
3248  */
3249 
3250 /**
3251  * DOC: Frame filtering
3252  *
3253  * mac80211 requires to see many management frames for proper
3254  * operation, and users may want to see many more frames when
3255  * in monitor mode. However, for best CPU usage and power consumption,
3256  * having as few frames as possible percolate through the stack is
3257  * desirable. Hence, the hardware should filter as much as possible.
3258  *
3259  * To achieve this, mac80211 uses filter flags (see below) to tell
3260  * the driver's configure_filter() function which frames should be
3261  * passed to mac80211 and which should be filtered out.
3262  *
3263  * Before configure_filter() is invoked, the prepare_multicast()
3264  * callback is invoked with the parameters @mc_count and @mc_list
3265  * for the combined multicast address list of all virtual interfaces.
3266  * It's use is optional, and it returns a u64 that is passed to
3267  * configure_filter(). Additionally, configure_filter() has the
3268  * arguments @changed_flags telling which flags were changed and
3269  * @total_flags with the new flag states.
3270  *
3271  * If your device has no multicast address filters your driver will
3272  * need to check both the %FIF_ALLMULTI flag and the @mc_count
3273  * parameter to see whether multicast frames should be accepted
3274  * or dropped.
3275  *
3276  * All unsupported flags in @total_flags must be cleared.
3277  * Hardware does not support a flag if it is incapable of _passing_
3278  * the frame to the stack. Otherwise the driver must ignore
3279  * the flag, but not clear it.
3280  * You must _only_ clear the flag (announce no support for the
3281  * flag to mac80211) if you are not able to pass the packet type
3282  * to the stack (so the hardware always filters it).
3283  * So for example, you should clear @FIF_CONTROL, if your hardware
3284  * always filters control frames. If your hardware always passes
3285  * control frames to the kernel and is incapable of filtering them,
3286  * you do _not_ clear the @FIF_CONTROL flag.
3287  * This rule applies to all other FIF flags as well.
3288  */
3289 
3290 /**
3291  * DOC: AP support for powersaving clients
3292  *
3293  * In order to implement AP and P2P GO modes, mac80211 has support for
3294  * client powersaving, both "legacy" PS (PS-Poll/null data) and uAPSD.
3295  * There currently is no support for sAPSD.
3296  *
3297  * There is one assumption that mac80211 makes, namely that a client
3298  * will not poll with PS-Poll and trigger with uAPSD at the same time.
3299  * Both are supported, and both can be used by the same client, but
3300  * they can't be used concurrently by the same client. This simplifies
3301  * the driver code.
3302  *
3303  * The first thing to keep in mind is that there is a flag for complete
3304  * driver implementation: %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS. If this flag is set,
3305  * mac80211 expects the driver to handle most of the state machine for
3306  * powersaving clients and will ignore the PM bit in incoming frames.
3307  * Drivers then use ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() to inform mac80211 of
3308  * stations' powersave transitions. In this mode, mac80211 also doesn't
3309  * handle PS-Poll/uAPSD.
3310  *
3311  * In the mode without %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS, mac80211 will check the
3312  * PM bit in incoming frames for client powersave transitions. When a
3313  * station goes to sleep, we will stop transmitting to it. There is,
3314  * however, a race condition: a station might go to sleep while there is
3315  * data buffered on hardware queues. If the device has support for this
3316  * it will reject frames, and the driver should give the frames back to
3317  * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED flag set which will
3318  * cause mac80211 to retry the frame when the station wakes up. The
3319  * driver is also notified of powersave transitions by calling its
3320  * @sta_notify callback.
3321  *
3322  * When the station is asleep, it has three choices: it can wake up,
3323  * it can PS-Poll, or it can possibly start a uAPSD service period.
3324  * Waking up is implemented by simply transmitting all buffered (and
3325  * filtered) frames to the station. This is the easiest case. When
3326  * the station sends a PS-Poll or a uAPSD trigger frame, mac80211
3327  * will inform the driver of this with the @allow_buffered_frames
3328  * callback; this callback is optional. mac80211 will then transmit
3329  * the frames as usual and set the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER
3330  * on each frame. The last frame in the service period (or the only
3331  * response to a PS-Poll) also has %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set to
3332  * indicate that it ends the service period; as this frame must have
3333  * TX status report it also sets %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS.
3334  * When TX status is reported for this frame, the service period is
3335  * marked has having ended and a new one can be started by the peer.
3336  *
3337  * Additionally, non-bufferable MMPDUs can also be transmitted by
3338  * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER set in them.
3339  *
3340  * Another race condition can happen on some devices like iwlwifi
3341  * when there are frames queued for the station and it wakes up
3342  * or polls; the frames that are already queued could end up being
3343  * transmitted first instead, causing reordering and/or wrong
3344  * processing of the EOSP. The cause is that allowing frames to be
3345  * transmitted to a certain station is out-of-band communication to
3346  * the device. To allow this problem to be solved, the driver can
3347  * call ieee80211_sta_block_awake() if frames are buffered when it
3348  * is notified that the station went to sleep. When all these frames
3349  * have been filtered (see above), it must call the function again
3350  * to indicate that the station is no longer blocked.
3351  *
3352  * If the driver buffers frames in the driver for aggregation in any
3353  * way, it must use the ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() call when it is
3354  * notified of the station going to sleep to inform mac80211 of any
3355  * TIDs that have frames buffered. Note that when a station wakes up
3356  * this information is reset (hence the requirement to call it when
3357  * informed of the station going to sleep). Then, when a service
3358  * period starts for any reason, @release_buffered_frames is called
3359  * with the number of frames to be released and which TIDs they are
3360  * to come from. In this case, the driver is responsible for setting
3361  * the EOSP (for uAPSD) and MORE_DATA bits in the released frames,
3362  * to help the @more_data parameter is passed to tell the driver if
3363  * there is more data on other TIDs -- the TIDs to release frames
3364  * from are ignored since mac80211 doesn't know how many frames the
3365  * buffers for those TIDs contain.
3366  *
3367  * If the driver also implement GO mode, where absence periods may
3368  * shorten service periods (or abort PS-Poll responses), it must
3369  * filter those response frames except in the case of frames that
3370  * are buffered in the driver -- those must remain buffered to avoid
3371  * reordering. Because it is possible that no frames are released
3372  * in this case, the driver must call ieee80211_sta_eosp()
3373  * to indicate to mac80211 that the service period ended anyway.
3374  *
3375  * Finally, if frames from multiple TIDs are released from mac80211
3376  * but the driver might reorder them, it must clear & set the flags
3377  * appropriately (only the last frame may have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP)
3378  * and also take care of the EOSP and MORE_DATA bits in the frame.
3379  * The driver may also use ieee80211_sta_eosp() in this case.
3380  *
3381  * Note that if the driver ever buffers frames other than QoS-data
3382  * frames, it must take care to never send a non-QoS-data frame as
3383  * the last frame in a service period, adding a QoS-nulldata frame
3384  * after a non-QoS-data frame if needed.
3385  */
3386 
3387 /**
3388  * DOC: HW queue control
3389  *
3390  * Before HW queue control was introduced, mac80211 only had a single static
3391  * assignment of per-interface AC software queues to hardware queues. This
3392  * was problematic for a few reasons:
3393  * 1) off-channel transmissions might get stuck behind other frames
3394  * 2) multiple virtual interfaces couldn't be handled correctly
3395  * 3) after-DTIM frames could get stuck behind other frames
3396  *
3397  * To solve this, hardware typically uses multiple different queues for all
3398  * the different usages, and this needs to be propagated into mac80211 so it
3399  * won't have the same problem with the software queues.
3400  *
3401  * Therefore, mac80211 now offers the %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL capability
3402  * flag that tells it that the driver implements its own queue control. To do
3403  * so, the driver will set up the various queues in each &struct ieee80211_vif
3404  * and the offchannel queue in &struct ieee80211_hw. In response, mac80211 will
3405  * use those queue IDs in the hw_queue field of &struct ieee80211_tx_info and
3406  * if necessary will queue the frame on the right software queue that mirrors
3407  * the hardware queue.
3408  * Additionally, the driver has to then use these HW queue IDs for the queue
3409  * management functions (ieee80211_stop_queue() et al.)
3410  *
3411  * The driver is free to set up the queue mappings as needed, multiple virtual
3412  * interfaces may map to the same hardware queues if needed. The setup has to
3413  * happen during add_interface or change_interface callbacks. For example, a
3414  * driver supporting station+station and station+AP modes might decide to have
3415  * 10 hardware queues to handle different scenarios:
3416  *
3417  * 4 AC HW queues for 1st vif: 0, 1, 2, 3
3418  * 4 AC HW queues for 2nd vif: 4, 5, 6, 7
3419  * after-DTIM queue for AP:   8
3420  * off-channel queue:         9
3421  *
3422  * It would then set up the hardware like this:
3423  *   hw.offchannel_tx_hw_queue = 9
3424  *
3425  * and the first virtual interface that is added as follows:
3426  *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VO] = 0
3427  *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VI] = 1
3428  *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BE] = 2
3429  *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BK] = 3
3430  *   vif.cab_queue = 8 // if AP mode, otherwise %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE
3431  * and the second virtual interface with 4-7.
3432  *
3433  * If queue 6 gets full, for example, mac80211 would only stop the second
3434  * virtual interface's BE queue since virtual interface queues are per AC.
3435  *
3436  * Note that the vif.cab_queue value should be set to %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE
3437  * whenever the queue is not used (i.e. the interface is not in AP mode) if the
3438  * queue could potentially be shared since mac80211 will look at cab_queue when
3439  * a queue is stopped/woken even if the interface is not in AP mode.
3440  */
3441 
3442 /**
3443  * enum ieee80211_filter_flags - hardware filter flags
3444  *
3445  * These flags determine what the filter in hardware should be
3446  * programmed to let through and what should not be passed to the
3447  * stack. It is always safe to pass more frames than requested,
3448  * but this has negative impact on power consumption.
3449  *
3450  * @FIF_ALLMULTI: pass all multicast frames, this is used if requested
3451  *	by the user or if the hardware is not capable of filtering by
3452  *	multicast address.
3453  *
3454  * @FIF_FCSFAIL: pass frames with failed FCS (but you need to set the
3455  *	%RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC for them)
3456  *
3457  * @FIF_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with failed PLCP CRC (but you need to set
3458  *	the %RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC for them
3459  *
3460  * @FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC: This flag is set during scanning to indicate
3461  *	to the hardware that it should not filter beacons or probe responses
3462  *	by BSSID. Filtering them can greatly reduce the amount of processing
3463  *	mac80211 needs to do and the amount of CPU wakeups, so you should
3464  *	honour this flag if possible.
3465  *
3466  * @FIF_CONTROL: pass control frames (except for PS Poll) addressed to this
3467  *	station
3468  *
3469  * @FIF_OTHER_BSS: pass frames destined to other BSSes
3470  *
3471  * @FIF_PSPOLL: pass PS Poll frames
3472  *
3473  * @FIF_PROBE_REQ: pass probe request frames
3474  *
3475  * @FIF_MCAST_ACTION: pass multicast Action frames
3476  */
3477 enum ieee80211_filter_flags {
3478 	FIF_ALLMULTI		= 1<<1,
3479 	FIF_FCSFAIL		= 1<<2,
3480 	FIF_PLCPFAIL		= 1<<3,
3481 	FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC	= 1<<4,
3482 	FIF_CONTROL		= 1<<5,
3483 	FIF_OTHER_BSS		= 1<<6,
3484 	FIF_PSPOLL		= 1<<7,
3485 	FIF_PROBE_REQ		= 1<<8,
3486 	FIF_MCAST_ACTION	= 1<<9,
3487 };
3488 
3489 /**
3490  * enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action - A-MPDU actions
3491  *
3492  * These flags are used with the ampdu_action() callback in
3493  * &struct ieee80211_ops to indicate which action is needed.
3494  *
3495  * Note that drivers MUST be able to deal with a TX aggregation
3496  * session being stopped even before they OK'ed starting it by
3497  * calling ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe, because the peer
3498  * might receive the addBA frame and send a delBA right away!
3499  *
3500  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START: start RX aggregation
3501  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP: stop RX aggregation
3502  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START: start TX aggregation, the driver must either
3503  *	call ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() or
3504  *	call ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() with status
3505  *	%IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_DELAY_ADDBA to delay addba after
3506  *	ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe is called, or just return the special
3507  *	status %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE.
3508  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL: TX aggregation has become operational
3509  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT: stop TX aggregation but continue transmitting
3510  *	queued packets, now unaggregated. After all packets are transmitted the
3511  *	driver has to call ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe().
3512  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH: stop TX aggregation and flush all packets,
3513  *	called when the station is removed. There's no need or reason to call
3514  *	ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() in this case as mac80211 assumes the
3515  *	session is gone and removes the station.
3516  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT: called when TX aggregation is stopped
3517  *	but the driver hasn't called ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() yet and
3518  *	now the connection is dropped and the station will be removed. Drivers
3519  *	should clean up and drop remaining packets when this is called.
3520  */
3521 enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action {
3522 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START,
3523 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP,
3524 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START,
3525 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT,
3526 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH,
3527 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT,
3528 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL,
3529 };
3530 
3531 #define IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE 1
3532 #define IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_DELAY_ADDBA 2
3533 
3534 /**
3535  * struct ieee80211_ampdu_params - AMPDU action parameters
3536  *
3537  * @action: the ampdu action, value from %ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action.
3538  * @sta: peer of this AMPDU session
3539  * @tid: tid of the BA session
3540  * @ssn: start sequence number of the session. TX/RX_STOP can pass 0. When
3541  *	action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START the driver passes back the
3542  *	actual ssn value used to start the session and writes the value here.
3543  * @buf_size: reorder buffer size  (number of subframes). Valid only when the
3544  *	action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START or
3545  *	%IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL
3546  * @amsdu: indicates the peer's ability to receive A-MSDU within A-MPDU.
3547  *	valid when the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL
3548  * @timeout: BA session timeout. Valid only when the action is set to
3549  *	%IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START
3550  */
3551 struct ieee80211_ampdu_params {
3552 	enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action action;
3553 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
3554 	u16 tid;
3555 	u16 ssn;
3556 	u16 buf_size;
3557 	bool amsdu;
3558 	u16 timeout;
3559 };
3560 
3561 /**
3562  * enum ieee80211_frame_release_type - frame release reason
3563  * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL: frame released for PS-Poll
3564  * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD: frame(s) released due to
3565  *	frame received on trigger-enabled AC
3566  */
3567 enum ieee80211_frame_release_type {
3568 	IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL,
3569 	IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD,
3570 };
3571 
3572 /**
3573  * enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed - flags to indicate what changed
3574  *
3575  * @IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED: The bandwidth that can be used to transmit
3576  *	to this station changed. The actual bandwidth is in the station
3577  *	information -- for HT20/40 the IEEE80211_HT_CAP_SUP_WIDTH_20_40
3578  *	flag changes, for HT and VHT the bandwidth field changes.
3579  * @IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED: The SMPS state of the station changed.
3580  * @IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED: The supported rate set of this peer
3581  *	changed (in IBSS mode) due to discovering more information about
3582  *	the peer.
3583  * @IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED: N_SS (number of spatial streams) was changed
3584  *	by the peer
3585  */
3586 enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed {
3587 	IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED		= BIT(0),
3588 	IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED	= BIT(1),
3589 	IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED	= BIT(2),
3590 	IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED	= BIT(3),
3591 };
3592 
3593 /**
3594  * enum ieee80211_roc_type - remain on channel type
3595  *
3596  * With the support for multi channel contexts and multi channel operations,
3597  * remain on channel operations might be limited/deferred/aborted by other
3598  * flows/operations which have higher priority (and vice versa).
3599  * Specifying the ROC type can be used by devices to prioritize the ROC
3600  * operations compared to other operations/flows.
3601  *
3602  * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL: There are no special requirements for this ROC.
3603  * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX: The remain on channel request is required
3604  *	for sending management frames offchannel.
3605  */
3606 enum ieee80211_roc_type {
3607 	IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL = 0,
3608 	IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX,
3609 };
3610 
3611 /**
3612  * enum ieee80211_reconfig_type - reconfig type
3613  *
3614  * This enum is used by the reconfig_complete() callback to indicate what
3615  * reconfiguration type was completed.
3616  *
3617  * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART: hw restart type
3618  *	(also due to resume() callback returning 1)
3619  * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND: suspend type (regardless
3620  *	of wowlan configuration)
3621  */
3622 enum ieee80211_reconfig_type {
3623 	IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART,
3624 	IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND,
3625 };
3626 
3627 /**
3628  * struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info - prepare TX information
3629  * @duration: if non-zero, hint about the required duration,
3630  *	only used with the mgd_prepare_tx() method.
3631  * @subtype: frame subtype (auth, (re)assoc, deauth, disassoc)
3632  * @success: whether the frame exchange was successful, only
3633  *	used with the mgd_complete_tx() method, and then only
3634  *	valid for auth and (re)assoc.
3635  */
3636 struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info {
3637 	u16 duration;
3638 	u16 subtype;
3639 	u8 success:1;
3640 };
3641 
3642 /**
3643  * struct ieee80211_ops - callbacks from mac80211 to the driver
3644  *
3645  * This structure contains various callbacks that the driver may
3646  * handle or, in some cases, must handle, for example to configure
3647  * the hardware to a new channel or to transmit a frame.
3648  *
3649  * @tx: Handler that 802.11 module calls for each transmitted frame.
3650  *	skb contains the buffer starting from the IEEE 802.11 header.
3651  *	The low-level driver should send the frame out based on
3652  *	configuration in the TX control data. This handler should,
3653  *	preferably, never fail and stop queues appropriately.
3654  *	Must be atomic.
3655  *
3656  * @start: Called before the first netdevice attached to the hardware
3657  *	is enabled. This should turn on the hardware and must turn on
3658  *	frame reception (for possibly enabled monitor interfaces.)
3659  *	Returns negative error codes, these may be seen in userspace,
3660  *	or zero.
3661  *	When the device is started it should not have a MAC address
3662  *	to avoid acknowledging frames before a non-monitor device
3663  *	is added.
3664  *	Must be implemented and can sleep.
3665  *
3666  * @stop: Called after last netdevice attached to the hardware
3667  *	is disabled. This should turn off the hardware (at least
3668  *	it must turn off frame reception.)
3669  *	May be called right after add_interface if that rejects
3670  *	an interface. If you added any work onto the mac80211 workqueue
3671  *	you should ensure to cancel it on this callback.
3672  *	Must be implemented and can sleep.
3673  *
3674  * @suspend: Suspend the device; mac80211 itself will quiesce before and
3675  *	stop transmitting and doing any other configuration, and then
3676  *	ask the device to suspend. This is only invoked when WoWLAN is
3677  *	configured, otherwise the device is deconfigured completely and
3678  *	reconfigured at resume time.
3679  *	The driver may also impose special conditions under which it
3680  *	wants to use the "normal" suspend (deconfigure), say if it only
3681  *	supports WoWLAN when the device is associated. In this case, it
3682  *	must return 1 from this function.
3683  *
3684  * @resume: If WoWLAN was configured, this indicates that mac80211 is
3685  *	now resuming its operation, after this the device must be fully
3686  *	functional again. If this returns an error, the only way out is
3687  *	to also unregister the device. If it returns 1, then mac80211
3688  *	will also go through the regular complete restart on resume.
3689  *
3690  * @set_wakeup: Enable or disable wakeup when WoWLAN configuration is
3691  *	modified. The reason is that device_set_wakeup_enable() is
3692  *	supposed to be called when the configuration changes, not only
3693  *	in suspend().
3694  *
3695  * @add_interface: Called when a netdevice attached to the hardware is
3696  *	enabled. Because it is not called for monitor mode devices, @start
3697  *	and @stop must be implemented.
3698  *	The driver should perform any initialization it needs before
3699  *	the device can be enabled. The initial configuration for the
3700  *	interface is given in the conf parameter.
3701  *	The callback may refuse to add an interface by returning a
3702  *	negative error code (which will be seen in userspace.)
3703  *	Must be implemented and can sleep.
3704  *
3705  * @change_interface: Called when a netdevice changes type. This callback
3706  *	is optional, but only if it is supported can interface types be
3707  *	switched while the interface is UP. The callback may sleep.
3708  *	Note that while an interface is being switched, it will not be
3709  *	found by the interface iteration callbacks.
3710  *
3711  * @remove_interface: Notifies a driver that an interface is going down.
3712  *	The @stop callback is called after this if it is the last interface
3713  *	and no monitor interfaces are present.
3714  *	When all interfaces are removed, the MAC address in the hardware
3715  *	must be cleared so the device no longer acknowledges packets,
3716  *	the mac_addr member of the conf structure is, however, set to the
3717  *	MAC address of the device going away.
3718  *	Hence, this callback must be implemented. It can sleep.
3719  *
3720  * @config: Handler for configuration requests. IEEE 802.11 code calls this
3721  *	function to change hardware configuration, e.g., channel.
3722  *	This function should never fail but returns a negative error code
3723  *	if it does. The callback can sleep.
3724  *
3725  * @bss_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to BSS
3726  *	parameters that may vary during BSS's lifespan, and may affect low
3727  *	level driver (e.g. assoc/disassoc status, erp parameters).
3728  *	This function should not be used if no BSS has been set, unless
3729  *	for association indication. The @changed parameter indicates which
3730  *	of the bss parameters has changed when a call is made. The callback
3731  *	can sleep.
3732  *	Note: this callback is called if @vif_cfg_changed or @link_info_changed
3733  *	are not implemented.
3734  *
3735  * @vif_cfg_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to interface
3736  *	(MLD) parameters from &struct ieee80211_vif_cfg that vary during the
3737  *	lifetime of the interface (e.g. assoc status, IP addresses, etc.)
3738  *	The @changed parameter indicates which value changed.
3739  *	The callback can sleep.
3740  *
3741  * @link_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to link
3742  *	parameters from &struct ieee80211_bss_conf that are related to an
3743  *	individual link. e.g. legacy/HT/VHT/... rate information.
3744  *	The @changed parameter indicates which value changed, and the @link_id
3745  *	parameter indicates the link ID. Note that the @link_id will be 0 for
3746  *	non-MLO connections.
3747  *	The callback can sleep.
3748  *
3749  * @prepare_multicast: Prepare for multicast filter configuration.
3750  *	This callback is optional, and its return value is passed
3751  *	to configure_filter(). This callback must be atomic.
3752  *
3753  * @configure_filter: Configure the device's RX filter.
3754  *	See the section "Frame filtering" for more information.
3755  *	This callback must be implemented and can sleep.
3756  *
3757  * @config_iface_filter: Configure the interface's RX filter.
3758  *	This callback is optional and is used to configure which frames
3759  *	should be passed to mac80211. The filter_flags is the combination
3760  *	of FIF_* flags. The changed_flags is a bit mask that indicates
3761  *	which flags are changed.
3762  *	This callback can sleep.
3763  *
3764  * @set_tim: Set TIM bit. mac80211 calls this function when a TIM bit
3765  * 	must be set or cleared for a given STA. Must be atomic.
3766  *
3767  * @set_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration"
3768  *	This callback is only called between add_interface and
3769  *	remove_interface calls, i.e. while the given virtual interface
3770  *	is enabled.
3771  *	Returns a negative error code if the key can't be added.
3772  *	The callback can sleep.
3773  *
3774  * @update_tkip_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration"
3775  * 	This callback will be called in the context of Rx. Called for drivers
3776  * 	which set IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_TKIP_REQ_RX_P1_KEY.
3777  *	The callback must be atomic.
3778  *
3779  * @set_rekey_data: If the device supports GTK rekeying, for example while the
3780  *	host is suspended, it can assign this callback to retrieve the data
3781  *	necessary to do GTK rekeying, this is the KEK, KCK and replay counter.
3782  *	After rekeying was done it should (for example during resume) notify
3783  *	userspace of the new replay counter using ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify().
3784  *
3785  * @set_default_unicast_key: Set the default (unicast) key index, useful for
3786  *	WEP when the device sends data packets autonomously, e.g. for ARP
3787  *	offloading. The index can be 0-3, or -1 for unsetting it.
3788  *
3789  * @hw_scan: Ask the hardware to service the scan request, no need to start
3790  *	the scan state machine in stack. The scan must honour the channel
3791  *	configuration done by the regulatory agent in the wiphy's
3792  *	registered bands. The hardware (or the driver) needs to make sure
3793  *	that power save is disabled.
3794  *	The @req ie/ie_len members are rewritten by mac80211 to contain the
3795  *	entire IEs after the SSID, so that drivers need not look at these
3796  *	at all but just send them after the SSID -- mac80211 includes the
3797  *	(extended) supported rates and HT information (where applicable).
3798  *	When the scan finishes, ieee80211_scan_completed() must be called;
3799  *	note that it also must be called when the scan cannot finish due to
3800  *	any error unless this callback returned a negative error code.
3801  *	This callback is also allowed to return the special return value 1,
3802  *	this indicates that hardware scan isn't desirable right now and a
3803  *	software scan should be done instead. A driver wishing to use this
3804  *	capability must ensure its (hardware) scan capabilities aren't
3805  *	advertised as more capable than mac80211's software scan is.
3806  *	The callback can sleep.
3807  *
3808  * @cancel_hw_scan: Ask the low-level tp cancel the active hw scan.
3809  *	The driver should ask the hardware to cancel the scan (if possible),
3810  *	but the scan will be completed only after the driver will call
3811  *	ieee80211_scan_completed().
3812  *	This callback is needed for wowlan, to prevent enqueueing a new
3813  *	scan_work after the low-level driver was already suspended.
3814  *	The callback can sleep.
3815  *
3816  * @sched_scan_start: Ask the hardware to start scanning repeatedly at
3817  *	specific intervals.  The driver must call the
3818  *	ieee80211_sched_scan_results() function whenever it finds results.
3819  *	This process will continue until sched_scan_stop is called.
3820  *
3821  * @sched_scan_stop: Tell the hardware to stop an ongoing scheduled scan.
3822  *	In this case, ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped() must not be called.
3823  *
3824  * @sw_scan_start: Notifier function that is called just before a software scan
3825  *	is started. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need this notification.
3826  *	The mac_addr parameter allows supporting NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR,
3827  *	the driver may set the NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR flag if it
3828  *	can use this parameter. The callback can sleep.
3829  *
3830  * @sw_scan_complete: Notifier function that is called just after a
3831  *	software scan finished. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need
3832  *	this notification.
3833  *	The callback can sleep.
3834  *
3835  * @get_stats: Return low-level statistics.
3836  * 	Returns zero if statistics are available.
3837  *	The callback can sleep.
3838  *
3839  * @get_key_seq: If your device implements encryption in hardware and does
3840  *	IV/PN assignment then this callback should be provided to read the
3841  *	IV/PN for the given key from hardware.
3842  *	The callback must be atomic.
3843  *
3844  * @set_frag_threshold: Configuration of fragmentation threshold. Assign this
3845  *	if the device does fragmentation by itself. Note that to prevent the
3846  *	stack from doing fragmentation IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG
3847  *	should be set as well.
3848  *	The callback can sleep.
3849  *
3850  * @set_rts_threshold: Configuration of RTS threshold (if device needs it)
3851  *	The callback can sleep.
3852  *
3853  * @sta_add: Notifies low level driver about addition of an associated station,
3854  *	AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. This callback can sleep.
3855  *
3856  * @sta_remove: Notifies low level driver about removal of an associated
3857  *	station, AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. Note that after the callback
3858  *	returns it isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected;
3859  *	no RCU grace period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing
3860  *	the station. See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed.
3861  *	This callback can sleep.
3862  *
3863  * @link_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
3864  *	when a link is added to a mac80211 vif. This callback should be within
3865  *	a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This callback can sleep.
3866  *	For non-MLO the callback will be called once for the default bss_conf
3867  *	with the vif's directory rather than a separate subdirectory.
3868  *
3869  * @sta_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
3870  *	when a station is added to mac80211's station list. This callback
3871  *	should be within a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This
3872  *	callback can sleep.
3873  *
3874  * @link_sta_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
3875  *	when a link is added to a mac80211 station. This callback
3876  *	should be within a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This
3877  *	callback can sleep.
3878  *	For non-MLO the callback will be called once for the deflink with the
3879  *	station's directory rather than a separate subdirectory.
3880  *
3881  * @sta_notify: Notifies low level driver about power state transition of an
3882  *	associated station, AP,  IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. For a VIF operating
3883  *	in AP mode, this callback will not be called when the flag
3884  *	%IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS is set. Must be atomic.
3885  *
3886  * @sta_set_txpwr: Configure the station tx power. This callback set the tx
3887  *	power for the station.
3888  *	This callback can sleep.
3889  *
3890  * @sta_state: Notifies low level driver about state transition of a
3891  *	station (which can be the AP, a client, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc.)
3892  *	This callback is mutually exclusive with @sta_add/@sta_remove.
3893  *	It must not fail for down transitions but may fail for transitions
3894  *	up the list of states. Also note that after the callback returns it
3895  *	isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected - no RCU grace
3896  *	period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing the station.
3897  *	See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed.
3898  *	The callback can sleep.
3899  *
3900  * @sta_pre_rcu_remove: Notify driver about station removal before RCU
3901  *	synchronisation. This is useful if a driver needs to have station
3902  *	pointers protected using RCU, it can then use this call to clear
3903  *	the pointers instead of waiting for an RCU grace period to elapse
3904  *	in @sta_state.
3905  *	The callback can sleep.
3906  *
3907  * @sta_rc_update: Notifies the driver of changes to the bitrates that can be
3908  *	used to transmit to the station. The changes are advertised with bits
3909  *	from &enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed and the values are reflected
3910  *	in the station data. This callback should only be used when the driver
3911  *	uses hardware rate control (%IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL) since
3912  *	otherwise the rate control algorithm is notified directly.
3913  *	Must be atomic.
3914  * @sta_rate_tbl_update: Notifies the driver that the rate table changed. This
3915  *	is only used if the configured rate control algorithm actually uses
3916  *	the new rate table API, and is therefore optional. Must be atomic.
3917  *
3918  * @sta_statistics: Get statistics for this station. For example with beacon
3919  *	filtering, the statistics kept by mac80211 might not be accurate, so
3920  *	let the driver pre-fill the statistics. The driver can fill most of
3921  *	the values (indicating which by setting the filled bitmap), but not
3922  *	all of them make sense - see the source for which ones are possible.
3923  *	Statistics that the driver doesn't fill will be filled by mac80211.
3924  *	The callback can sleep.
3925  *
3926  * @conf_tx: Configure TX queue parameters (EDCF (aifs, cw_min, cw_max),
3927  *	bursting) for a hardware TX queue.
3928  *	Returns a negative error code on failure.
3929  *	The callback can sleep.
3930  *
3931  * @get_tsf: Get the current TSF timer value from firmware/hardware. Currently,
3932  *	this is only used for IBSS mode BSSID merging and debugging. Is not a
3933  *	required function.
3934  *	The callback can sleep.
3935  *
3936  * @set_tsf: Set the TSF timer to the specified value in the firmware/hardware.
3937  *	Currently, this is only used for IBSS mode debugging. Is not a
3938  *	required function.
3939  *	The callback can sleep.
3940  *
3941  * @offset_tsf: Offset the TSF timer by the specified value in the
3942  *	firmware/hardware.  Preferred to set_tsf as it avoids delay between
3943  *	calling set_tsf() and hardware getting programmed, which will show up
3944  *	as TSF delay. Is not a required function.
3945  *	The callback can sleep.
3946  *
3947  * @reset_tsf: Reset the TSF timer and allow firmware/hardware to synchronize
3948  *	with other STAs in the IBSS. This is only used in IBSS mode. This
3949  *	function is optional if the firmware/hardware takes full care of
3950  *	TSF synchronization.
3951  *	The callback can sleep.
3952  *
3953  * @tx_last_beacon: Determine whether the last IBSS beacon was sent by us.
3954  *	This is needed only for IBSS mode and the result of this function is
3955  *	used to determine whether to reply to Probe Requests.
3956  *	Returns non-zero if this device sent the last beacon.
3957  *	The callback can sleep.
3958  *
3959  * @get_survey: Return per-channel survey information
3960  *
3961  * @rfkill_poll: Poll rfkill hardware state. If you need this, you also
3962  *	need to set wiphy->rfkill_poll to %true before registration,
3963  *	and need to call wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state() in the callback.
3964  *	The callback can sleep.
3965  *
3966  * @set_coverage_class: Set slot time for given coverage class as specified
3967  *	in IEEE 802.11-2007 section 17.3.8.6 and modify ACK timeout
3968  *	accordingly; coverage class equals to -1 to enable ACK timeout
3969  *	estimation algorithm (dynack). To disable dynack set valid value for
3970  *	coverage class. This callback is not required and may sleep.
3971  *
3972  * @testmode_cmd: Implement a cfg80211 test mode command. The passed @vif may
3973  *	be %NULL. The callback can sleep.
3974  * @testmode_dump: Implement a cfg80211 test mode dump. The callback can sleep.
3975  *
3976  * @flush: Flush all pending frames from the hardware queue, making sure
3977  *	that the hardware queues are empty. The @queues parameter is a bitmap
3978  *	of queues to flush, which is useful if different virtual interfaces
3979  *	use different hardware queues; it may also indicate all queues.
3980  *	If the parameter @drop is set to %true, pending frames may be dropped.
3981  *	Note that vif can be NULL.
3982  *	The callback can sleep.
3983  *
3984  * @flush_sta: Flush or drop all pending frames from the hardware queue(s) for
3985  *	the given station, as it's about to be removed.
3986  *	The callback can sleep.
3987  *
3988  * @channel_switch: Drivers that need (or want) to offload the channel
3989  *	switch operation for CSAs received from the AP may implement this
3990  *	callback. They must then call ieee80211_chswitch_done() to indicate
3991  *	completion of the channel switch.
3992  *
3993  * @set_antenna: Set antenna configuration (tx_ant, rx_ant) on the device.
3994  *	Parameters are bitmaps of allowed antennas to use for TX/RX. Drivers may
3995  *	reject TX/RX mask combinations they cannot support by returning -EINVAL
3996  *	(also see nl80211.h @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX).
3997  *
3998  * @get_antenna: Get current antenna configuration from device (tx_ant, rx_ant).
3999  *
4000  * @remain_on_channel: Starts an off-channel period on the given channel, must
4001  *	call back to ieee80211_ready_on_channel() when on that channel. Note
4002  *	that normal channel traffic is not stopped as this is intended for hw
4003  *	offload. Frames to transmit on the off-channel channel are transmitted
4004  *	normally except for the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN flag. When the
4005  *	duration (which will always be non-zero) expires, the driver must call
4006  *	ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired().
4007  *	Note that this callback may be called while the device is in IDLE and
4008  *	must be accepted in this case.
4009  *	This callback may sleep.
4010  * @cancel_remain_on_channel: Requests that an ongoing off-channel period is
4011  *	aborted before it expires. This callback may sleep.
4012  *
4013  * @set_ringparam: Set tx and rx ring sizes.
4014  *
4015  * @get_ringparam: Get tx and rx ring current and maximum sizes.
4016  *
4017  * @tx_frames_pending: Check if there is any pending frame in the hardware
4018  *	queues before entering power save.
4019  *
4020  * @set_bitrate_mask: Set a mask of rates to be used for rate control selection
4021  *	when transmitting a frame. Currently only legacy rates are handled.
4022  *	The callback can sleep.
4023  * @event_callback: Notify driver about any event in mac80211. See
4024  *	&enum ieee80211_event_type for the different types.
4025  *	The callback must be atomic.
4026  *
4027  * @release_buffered_frames: Release buffered frames according to the given
4028  *	parameters. In the case where the driver buffers some frames for
4029  *	sleeping stations mac80211 will use this callback to tell the driver
4030  *	to release some frames, either for PS-poll or uAPSD.
4031  *	Note that if the @more_data parameter is %false the driver must check
4032  *	if there are more frames on the given TIDs, and if there are more than
4033  *	the frames being released then it must still set the more-data bit in
4034  *	the frame. If the @more_data parameter is %true, then of course the
4035  *	more-data bit must always be set.
4036  *	The @tids parameter tells the driver which TIDs to release frames
4037  *	from, for PS-poll it will always have only a single bit set.
4038  *	In the case this is used for a PS-poll initiated release, the
4039  *	@num_frames parameter will always be 1 so code can be shared. In
4040  *	this case the driver must also set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag
4041  *	on the TX status (and must report TX status) so that the PS-poll
4042  *	period is properly ended. This is used to avoid sending multiple
4043  *	responses for a retried PS-poll frame.
4044  *	In the case this is used for uAPSD, the @num_frames parameter may be
4045  *	bigger than one, but the driver may send fewer frames (it must send
4046  *	at least one, however). In this case it is also responsible for
4047  *	setting the EOSP flag in the QoS header of the frames. Also, when the
4048  *	service period ends, the driver must set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP
4049  *	on the last frame in the SP. Alternatively, it may call the function
4050  *	ieee80211_sta_eosp() to inform mac80211 of the end of the SP.
4051  *	This callback must be atomic.
4052  * @allow_buffered_frames: Prepare device to allow the given number of frames
4053  *	to go out to the given station. The frames will be sent by mac80211
4054  *	via the usual TX path after this call. The TX information for frames
4055  *	released will also have the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER flag set
4056  *	and the last one will also have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set. In case
4057  *	frames from multiple TIDs are released and the driver might reorder
4058  *	them between the TIDs, it must set the %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag
4059  *	on the last frame and clear it on all others and also handle the EOSP
4060  *	bit in the QoS header correctly. Alternatively, it can also call the
4061  *	ieee80211_sta_eosp() function.
4062  *	The @tids parameter is a bitmap and tells the driver which TIDs the
4063  *	frames will be on; it will at most have two bits set.
4064  *	This callback must be atomic.
4065  *
4066  * @get_et_sset_count:  Ethtool API to get string-set count.
4067  *
4068  * @get_et_stats:  Ethtool API to get a set of u64 stats.
4069  *
4070  * @get_et_strings:  Ethtool API to get a set of strings to describe stats
4071  *	and perhaps other supported types of ethtool data-sets.
4072  *
4073  * @mgd_prepare_tx: Prepare for transmitting a management frame for association
4074  *	before associated. In multi-channel scenarios, a virtual interface is
4075  *	bound to a channel before it is associated, but as it isn't associated
4076  *	yet it need not necessarily be given airtime, in particular since any
4077  *	transmission to a P2P GO needs to be synchronized against the GO's
4078  *	powersave state. mac80211 will call this function before transmitting a
4079  *	management frame prior to having successfully associated to allow the
4080  *	driver to give it channel time for the transmission, to get a response
4081  *	and to be able to synchronize with the GO.
4082  *	For drivers that set %IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP, mac80211
4083  *	would also call this function before transmitting a deauthentication
4084  *	frame in case that no beacon was heard from the AP/P2P GO.
4085  *	The callback will be called before each transmission and upon return
4086  *	mac80211 will transmit the frame right away.
4087  *	Additional information is passed in the &struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info
4088  *	data. If duration there is greater than zero, mac80211 hints to the
4089  *	driver the duration for which the operation is requested.
4090  *	The callback is optional and can (should!) sleep.
4091  * @mgd_complete_tx: Notify the driver that the response frame for a previously
4092  *	transmitted frame announced with @mgd_prepare_tx was received, the data
4093  *	is filled similarly to @mgd_prepare_tx though the duration is not used.
4094  *
4095  * @mgd_protect_tdls_discover: Protect a TDLS discovery session. After sending
4096  *	a TDLS discovery-request, we expect a reply to arrive on the AP's
4097  *	channel. We must stay on the channel (no PSM, scan, etc.), since a TDLS
4098  *	setup-response is a direct packet not buffered by the AP.
4099  *	mac80211 will call this function just before the transmission of a TDLS
4100  *	discovery-request. The recommended period of protection is at least
4101  *	2 * (DTIM period).
4102  *	The callback is optional and can sleep.
4103  *
4104  * @add_chanctx: Notifies device driver about new channel context creation.
4105  *	This callback may sleep.
4106  * @remove_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context destruction.
4107  *	This callback may sleep.
4108  * @change_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context changes that
4109  *	may happen when combining different virtual interfaces on the same
4110  *	channel context with different settings
4111  *	This callback may sleep.
4112  * @assign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being bound
4113  *	to vif. Possible use is for hw queue remapping.
4114  *	This callback may sleep.
4115  * @unassign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being
4116  *	unbound from vif.
4117  *	This callback may sleep.
4118  * @switch_vif_chanctx: switch a number of vifs from one chanctx to
4119  *	another, as specified in the list of
4120  *	@ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch passed to the driver, according
4121  *	to the mode defined in &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode.
4122  *	This callback may sleep.
4123  *
4124  * @start_ap: Start operation on the AP interface, this is called after all the
4125  *	information in bss_conf is set and beacon can be retrieved. A channel
4126  *	context is bound before this is called. Note that if the driver uses
4127  *	software scan or ROC, this (and @stop_ap) isn't called when the AP is
4128  *	just "paused" for scanning/ROC, which is indicated by the beacon being
4129  *	disabled/enabled via @bss_info_changed.
4130  * @stop_ap: Stop operation on the AP interface.
4131  *
4132  * @reconfig_complete: Called after a call to ieee80211_restart_hw() and
4133  *	during resume, when the reconfiguration has completed.
4134  *	This can help the driver implement the reconfiguration step (and
4135  *	indicate mac80211 is ready to receive frames).
4136  *	This callback may sleep.
4137  *
4138  * @ipv6_addr_change: IPv6 address assignment on the given interface changed.
4139  *	Currently, this is only called for managed or P2P client interfaces.
4140  *	This callback is optional; it must not sleep.
4141  *
4142  * @channel_switch_beacon: Starts a channel switch to a new channel.
4143  *	Beacons are modified to include CSA or ECSA IEs before calling this
4144  *	function. The corresponding count fields in these IEs must be
4145  *	decremented, and when they reach 1 the driver must call
4146  *	ieee80211_csa_finish(). Drivers which use ieee80211_beacon_get()
4147  *	get the csa counter decremented by mac80211, but must check if it is
4148  *	1 using ieee80211_beacon_counter_is_complete() after the beacon has been
4149  *	transmitted and then call ieee80211_csa_finish().
4150  *	If the CSA count starts as zero or 1, this function will not be called,
4151  *	since there won't be any time to beacon before the switch anyway.
4152  * @pre_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4153  *	before a channel switch procedure is started (ie. when a STA
4154  *	gets a CSA or a userspace initiated channel-switch), allowing
4155  *	the driver to prepare for the channel switch.
4156  * @post_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4157  *	after a channel switch procedure is completed, allowing the
4158  *	driver to go back to a normal configuration.
4159  * @abort_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4160  *	when channel switch procedure was completed, allowing the
4161  *	driver to go back to a normal configuration.
4162  * @channel_switch_rx_beacon: This is an optional callback that is called
4163  *	when channel switch procedure is in progress and additional beacon with
4164  *	CSA IE was received, allowing driver to track changes in count.
4165  * @join_ibss: Join an IBSS (on an IBSS interface); this is called after all
4166  *	information in bss_conf is set up and the beacon can be retrieved. A
4167  *	channel context is bound before this is called.
4168  * @leave_ibss: Leave the IBSS again.
4169  *
4170  * @get_expected_throughput: extract the expected throughput towards the
4171  *	specified station. The returned value is expressed in Kbps. It returns 0
4172  *	if the RC algorithm does not have proper data to provide.
4173  *
4174  * @get_txpower: get current maximum tx power (in dBm) based on configuration
4175  *	and hardware limits.
4176  *
4177  * @tdls_channel_switch: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer. The driver
4178  *	is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching operations
4179  *	and returning to the base channel for communication with the AP. The
4180  *	driver receives a channel-switch request template and the location of
4181  *	the switch-timing IE within the template as part of the invocation.
4182  *	The template is valid only within the call, and the driver can
4183  *	optionally copy the skb for further re-use.
4184  * @tdls_cancel_channel_switch: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS peer. Both
4185  *	peers must be on the base channel when the call completes.
4186  * @tdls_recv_channel_switch: a TDLS channel-switch related frame (request or
4187  *	response) has been received from a remote peer. The driver gets
4188  *	parameters parsed from the incoming frame and may use them to continue
4189  *	an ongoing channel-switch operation. In addition, a channel-switch
4190  *	response template is provided, together with the location of the
4191  *	switch-timing IE within the template. The skb can only be used within
4192  *	the function call.
4193  *
4194  * @wake_tx_queue: Called when new packets have been added to the queue.
4195  * @sync_rx_queues: Process all pending frames in RSS queues. This is a
4196  *	synchronization which is needed in case driver has in its RSS queues
4197  *	pending frames that were received prior to the control path action
4198  *	currently taken (e.g. disassociation) but are not processed yet.
4199  *
4200  * @start_nan: join an existing NAN cluster, or create a new one.
4201  * @stop_nan: leave the NAN cluster.
4202  * @nan_change_conf: change NAN configuration. The data in cfg80211_nan_conf
4203  *	contains full new configuration and changes specify which parameters
4204  *	are changed with respect to the last NAN config.
4205  *	The driver gets both full configuration and the changed parameters since
4206  *	some devices may need the full configuration while others need only the
4207  *	changed parameters.
4208  * @add_nan_func: Add a NAN function. Returns 0 on success. The data in
4209  *	cfg80211_nan_func must not be referenced outside the scope of
4210  *	this call.
4211  * @del_nan_func: Remove a NAN function. The driver must call
4212  *	ieee80211_nan_func_terminated() with
4213  *	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_USER_REQUEST reason code upon removal.
4214  * @can_aggregate_in_amsdu: Called in order to determine if HW supports
4215  *	aggregating two specific frames in the same A-MSDU. The relation
4216  *	between the skbs should be symmetric and transitive. Note that while
4217  *	skb is always a real frame, head may or may not be an A-MSDU.
4218  * @get_ftm_responder_stats: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, if available.
4219  *	Statistics should be cumulative, currently no way to reset is provided.
4220  *
4221  * @start_pmsr: start peer measurement (e.g. FTM) (this call can sleep)
4222  * @abort_pmsr: abort peer measurement (this call can sleep)
4223  * @set_tid_config: Apply TID specific configurations. This callback may sleep.
4224  * @reset_tid_config: Reset TID specific configuration for the peer.
4225  *	This callback may sleep.
4226  * @update_vif_offload: Update virtual interface offload flags
4227  *	This callback may sleep.
4228  * @sta_set_4addr: Called to notify the driver when a station starts/stops using
4229  *	4-address mode
4230  * @set_sar_specs: Update the SAR (TX power) settings.
4231  * @sta_set_decap_offload: Called to notify the driver when a station is allowed
4232  *	to use rx decapsulation offload
4233  * @add_twt_setup: Update hw with TWT agreement parameters received from the peer.
4234  *	This callback allows the hw to check if requested parameters
4235  *	are supported and if there is enough room for a new agreement.
4236  *	The hw is expected to set agreement result in the req_type field of
4237  *	twt structure.
4238  * @twt_teardown_request: Update the hw with TWT teardown request received
4239  *	from the peer.
4240  * @set_radar_background: Configure dedicated offchannel chain available for
4241  *	radar/CAC detection on some hw. This chain can't be used to transmit
4242  *	or receive frames and it is bounded to a running wdev.
4243  *	Background radar/CAC detection allows to avoid the CAC downtime
4244  *	switching to a different channel during CAC detection on the selected
4245  *	radar channel.
4246  *	The caller is expected to set chandef pointer to NULL in order to
4247  *	disable background CAC/radar detection.
4248  * @net_fill_forward_path: Called from .ndo_fill_forward_path in order to
4249  *	resolve a path for hardware flow offloading
4250  * @change_vif_links: Change the valid links on an interface, note that while
4251  *	removing the old link information is still valid (link_conf pointer),
4252  *	but may immediately disappear after the function returns. The old or
4253  *	new links bitmaps may be 0 if going from/to a non-MLO situation.
4254  *	The @old array contains pointers to the old bss_conf structures
4255  *	that were already removed, in case they're needed.
4256  *	This callback can sleep.
4257  * @change_sta_links: Change the valid links of a station, similar to
4258  *	@change_vif_links. This callback can sleep.
4259  *	Note that a sta can also be inserted or removed with valid links,
4260  *	i.e. passed to @sta_add/@sta_state with sta->valid_links not zero.
4261  *	In fact, cannot change from having valid_links and not having them.
4262  * @set_hw_timestamp: Enable/disable HW timestamping of TM/FTM frames. This is
4263  *	not restored at HW reset by mac80211 so drivers need to take care of
4264  *	that.
4265  * @net_setup_tc: Called from .ndo_setup_tc in order to prepare hardware
4266  *	flow offloading for flows originating from the vif.
4267  *	Note that the driver must not assume that the vif driver_data is valid
4268  *	at this point, since the callback can be called during netdev teardown.
4269  */
4270 struct ieee80211_ops {
4271 	void (*tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4272 		   struct ieee80211_tx_control *control,
4273 		   struct sk_buff *skb);
4274 	int (*start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4275 	void (*stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4276 #ifdef CONFIG_PM
4277 	int (*suspend)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct cfg80211_wowlan *wowlan);
4278 	int (*resume)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4279 	void (*set_wakeup)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, bool enabled);
4280 #endif
4281 	int (*add_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4282 			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4283 	int (*change_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4284 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4285 				enum nl80211_iftype new_type, bool p2p);
4286 	void (*remove_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4287 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4288 	int (*config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 changed);
4289 	void (*bss_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4290 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4291 				 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info,
4292 				 u64 changed);
4293 	void (*vif_cfg_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4294 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4295 				u64 changed);
4296 	void (*link_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4297 				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4298 				  struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info,
4299 				  u64 changed);
4300 
4301 	int (*start_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4302 			struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4303 	void (*stop_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4304 			struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4305 
4306 	u64 (*prepare_multicast)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4307 				 struct netdev_hw_addr_list *mc_list);
4308 	void (*configure_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4309 				 unsigned int changed_flags,
4310 				 unsigned int *total_flags,
4311 				 u64 multicast);
4312 	void (*config_iface_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4313 				    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4314 				    unsigned int filter_flags,
4315 				    unsigned int changed_flags);
4316 	int (*set_tim)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4317 		       bool set);
4318 	int (*set_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, enum set_key_cmd cmd,
4319 		       struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4320 		       struct ieee80211_key_conf *key);
4321 	void (*update_tkip_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4322 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4323 				struct ieee80211_key_conf *conf,
4324 				struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4325 				u32 iv32, u16 *phase1key);
4326 	void (*set_rekey_data)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4327 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4328 			       struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data *data);
4329 	void (*set_default_unicast_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4330 					struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int idx);
4331 	int (*hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4332 		       struct ieee80211_scan_request *req);
4333 	void (*cancel_hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4334 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4335 	int (*sched_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4336 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4337 				struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *req,
4338 				struct ieee80211_scan_ies *ies);
4339 	int (*sched_scan_stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4340 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4341 	void (*sw_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4342 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4343 			      const u8 *mac_addr);
4344 	void (*sw_scan_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4345 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4346 	int (*get_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4347 			 struct ieee80211_low_level_stats *stats);
4348 	void (*get_key_seq)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4349 			    struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
4350 			    struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
4351 	int (*set_frag_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 value);
4352 	int (*set_rts_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 value);
4353 	int (*sta_add)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4354 		       struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4355 	int (*sta_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4356 			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4357 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS
4358 	void (*link_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4359 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4360 				 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4361 				 struct dentry *dir);
4362 	void (*sta_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4363 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4364 				struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4365 				struct dentry *dir);
4366 	void (*link_sta_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4367 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4368 				     struct ieee80211_link_sta *link_sta,
4369 				     struct dentry *dir);
4370 #endif
4371 	void (*sta_notify)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4372 			enum sta_notify_cmd, struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4373 	int (*sta_set_txpwr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4374 			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4375 			     struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4376 	int (*sta_state)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4377 			 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4378 			 enum ieee80211_sta_state old_state,
4379 			 enum ieee80211_sta_state new_state);
4380 	void (*sta_pre_rcu_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4381 				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4382 				   struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4383 	void (*sta_rc_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4384 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4385 			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4386 			      u32 changed);
4387 	void (*sta_rate_tbl_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4388 				    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4389 				    struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4390 	void (*sta_statistics)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4391 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4392 			       struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4393 			       struct station_info *sinfo);
4394 	int (*conf_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4395 		       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4396 		       unsigned int link_id, u16 ac,
4397 		       const struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params *params);
4398 	u64 (*get_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4399 	void (*set_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4400 			u64 tsf);
4401 	void (*offset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4402 			   s64 offset);
4403 	void (*reset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4404 	int (*tx_last_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4405 
4406 	/**
4407 	 * @ampdu_action:
4408 	 * Perform a certain A-MPDU action.
4409 	 * The RA/TID combination determines the destination and TID we want
4410 	 * the ampdu action to be performed for. The action is defined through
4411 	 * ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action.
4412 	 * When the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL the driver
4413 	 * may neither send aggregates containing more subframes than @buf_size
4414 	 * nor send aggregates in a way that lost frames would exceed the
4415 	 * buffer size. If just limiting the aggregate size, this would be
4416 	 * possible with a buf_size of 8:
4417 	 *
4418 	 * - ``TX: 1.....7``
4419 	 * - ``RX:  2....7`` (lost frame #1)
4420 	 * - ``TX:        8..1...``
4421 	 *
4422 	 * which is invalid since #1 was now re-transmitted well past the
4423 	 * buffer size of 8. Correct ways to retransmit #1 would be:
4424 	 *
4425 	 * - ``TX:        1   or``
4426 	 * - ``TX:        18  or``
4427 	 * - ``TX:        81``
4428 	 *
4429 	 * Even ``189`` would be wrong since 1 could be lost again.
4430 	 *
4431 	 * Returns a negative error code on failure. The driver may return
4432 	 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE for %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START
4433 	 * if the session can start immediately.
4434 	 *
4435 	 * The callback can sleep.
4436 	 */
4437 	int (*ampdu_action)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4438 			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4439 			    struct ieee80211_ampdu_params *params);
4440 	int (*get_survey)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int idx,
4441 		struct survey_info *survey);
4442 	void (*rfkill_poll)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4443 	void (*set_coverage_class)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, s16 coverage_class);
4444 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE
4445 	int (*testmode_cmd)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4446 			    void *data, int len);
4447 	int (*testmode_dump)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb,
4448 			     struct netlink_callback *cb,
4449 			     void *data, int len);
4450 #endif
4451 	void (*flush)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4452 		      u32 queues, bool drop);
4453 	void (*flush_sta)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4454 			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4455 	void (*channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4456 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4457 			       struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4458 	int (*set_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx_ant, u32 rx_ant);
4459 	int (*get_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 *tx_ant, u32 *rx_ant);
4460 
4461 	int (*remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4462 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4463 				 struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
4464 				 int duration,
4465 				 enum ieee80211_roc_type type);
4466 	int (*cancel_remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4467 					struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4468 	int (*set_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx, u32 rx);
4469 	void (*get_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4470 			      u32 *tx, u32 *tx_max, u32 *rx, u32 *rx_max);
4471 	bool (*tx_frames_pending)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4472 	int (*set_bitrate_mask)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4473 				const struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask *mask);
4474 	void (*event_callback)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4475 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4476 			       const struct ieee80211_event *event);
4477 
4478 	void (*allow_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4479 				      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4480 				      u16 tids, int num_frames,
4481 				      enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason,
4482 				      bool more_data);
4483 	void (*release_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4484 					struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4485 					u16 tids, int num_frames,
4486 					enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason,
4487 					bool more_data);
4488 
4489 	int	(*get_et_sset_count)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4490 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int sset);
4491 	void	(*get_et_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4492 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4493 				struct ethtool_stats *stats, u64 *data);
4494 	void	(*get_et_strings)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4495 				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4496 				  u32 sset, u8 *data);
4497 
4498 	void	(*mgd_prepare_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4499 				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4500 				  struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info *info);
4501 	void	(*mgd_complete_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4502 				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4503 				   struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info *info);
4504 
4505 	void	(*mgd_protect_tdls_discover)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4506 					     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4507 
4508 	int (*add_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4509 			   struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4510 	void (*remove_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4511 			       struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4512 	void (*change_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4513 			       struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx,
4514 			       u32 changed);
4515 	int (*assign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4516 				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4517 				  struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4518 				  struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4519 	void (*unassign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4520 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4521 				     struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4522 				     struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4523 	int (*switch_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4524 				  struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch *vifs,
4525 				  int n_vifs,
4526 				  enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode mode);
4527 
4528 	void (*reconfig_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4529 				  enum ieee80211_reconfig_type reconfig_type);
4530 
4531 #if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_IPV6)
4532 	void (*ipv6_addr_change)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4533 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4534 				 struct inet6_dev *idev);
4535 #endif
4536 	void (*channel_switch_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4537 				      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4538 				      struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4539 	int (*pre_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4540 				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4541 				  struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4542 
4543 	int (*post_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4544 				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4545 	void (*abort_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4546 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4547 	void (*channel_switch_rx_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4548 					 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4549 					 struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4550 
4551 	int (*join_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4552 	void (*leave_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4553 	u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4554 				       struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4555 	int (*get_txpower)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4556 			   int *dbm);
4557 
4558 	int (*tdls_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4559 				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4560 				   struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 oper_class,
4561 				   struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
4562 				   struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb, u32 ch_sw_tm_ie);
4563 	void (*tdls_cancel_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4564 					   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4565 					   struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4566 	void (*tdls_recv_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4567 					 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4568 					 struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params *params);
4569 
4570 	void (*wake_tx_queue)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4571 			      struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
4572 	void (*sync_rx_queues)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4573 
4574 	int (*start_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4575 			 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4576 			 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf);
4577 	int (*stop_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4578 			struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4579 	int (*nan_change_conf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4580 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4581 			       struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf, u32 changes);
4582 	int (*add_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4583 			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4584 			    const struct cfg80211_nan_func *nan_func);
4585 	void (*del_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4586 			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4587 			    u8 instance_id);
4588 	bool (*can_aggregate_in_amsdu)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4589 				       struct sk_buff *head,
4590 				       struct sk_buff *skb);
4591 	int (*get_ftm_responder_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4592 				       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4593 				       struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats *ftm_stats);
4594 	int (*start_pmsr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4595 			  struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4596 	void (*abort_pmsr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4597 			   struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4598 	int (*set_tid_config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4599 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4600 			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4601 			      struct cfg80211_tid_config *tid_conf);
4602 	int (*reset_tid_config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4603 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4604 				struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tids);
4605 	void (*update_vif_offload)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4606 				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4607 	void (*sta_set_4addr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4608 			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool enabled);
4609 	int (*set_sar_specs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4610 			     const struct cfg80211_sar_specs *sar);
4611 	void (*sta_set_decap_offload)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4612 				      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4613 				      struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool enabled);
4614 	void (*add_twt_setup)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4615 			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4616 			      struct ieee80211_twt_setup *twt);
4617 	void (*twt_teardown_request)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4618 				     struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 flowid);
4619 	int (*set_radar_background)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4620 				    struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4621 	int (*net_fill_forward_path)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4622 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4623 				     struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4624 				     struct net_device_path_ctx *ctx,
4625 				     struct net_device_path *path);
4626 	int (*change_vif_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4627 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4628 				u16 old_links, u16 new_links,
4629 				struct ieee80211_bss_conf *old[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS]);
4630 	int (*change_sta_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4631 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4632 				struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4633 				u16 old_links, u16 new_links);
4634 	int (*set_hw_timestamp)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4635 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4636 				struct cfg80211_set_hw_timestamp *hwts);
4637 	int (*net_setup_tc)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4638 			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4639 			    struct net_device *dev,
4640 			    enum tc_setup_type type,
4641 			    void *type_data);
4642 };
4643 
4644 /**
4645  * ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm - Allocate a new hardware device
4646  *
4647  * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer
4648  * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions.
4649  * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by
4650  * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as
4651  * @priv_data_len.
4652  *
4653  * @priv_data_len: length of private data
4654  * @ops: callbacks for this device
4655  * @requested_name: Requested name for this device.
4656  *	NULL is valid value, and means use the default naming (phy%d)
4657  *
4658  * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error.
4659  */
4660 struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(size_t priv_data_len,
4661 					   const struct ieee80211_ops *ops,
4662 					   const char *requested_name);
4663 
4664 /**
4665  * ieee80211_alloc_hw - Allocate a new hardware device
4666  *
4667  * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer
4668  * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions.
4669  * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by
4670  * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as
4671  * @priv_data_len.
4672  *
4673  * @priv_data_len: length of private data
4674  * @ops: callbacks for this device
4675  *
4676  * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error.
4677  */
4678 static inline
4679 struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw(size_t priv_data_len,
4680 					const struct ieee80211_ops *ops)
4681 {
4682 	return ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(priv_data_len, ops, NULL);
4683 }
4684 
4685 /**
4686  * ieee80211_register_hw - Register hardware device
4687  *
4688  * You must call this function before any other functions in
4689  * mac80211. Note that before a hardware can be registered, you
4690  * need to fill the contained wiphy's information.
4691  *
4692  * @hw: the device to register as returned by ieee80211_alloc_hw()
4693  *
4694  * Return: 0 on success. An error code otherwise.
4695  */
4696 int ieee80211_register_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4697 
4698 /**
4699  * struct ieee80211_tpt_blink - throughput blink description
4700  * @throughput: throughput in Kbit/sec
4701  * @blink_time: blink time in milliseconds
4702  *	(full cycle, ie. one off + one on period)
4703  */
4704 struct ieee80211_tpt_blink {
4705 	int throughput;
4706 	int blink_time;
4707 };
4708 
4709 /**
4710  * enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags - throughput trigger flags
4711  * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO: enable blinking with radio
4712  * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK: enable blinking when working
4713  * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED: enable blinking when at least one
4714  *	interface is connected in some way, including being an AP
4715  */
4716 enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags {
4717 	IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO		= BIT(0),
4718 	IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK		= BIT(1),
4719 	IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED	= BIT(2),
4720 };
4721 
4722 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4723 const char *__ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4724 const char *__ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4725 const char *__ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4726 const char *__ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4727 const char *
4728 __ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4729 				   unsigned int flags,
4730 				   const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table,
4731 				   unsigned int blink_table_len);
4732 #endif
4733 /**
4734  * ieee80211_get_tx_led_name - get name of TX LED
4735  *
4736  * mac80211 creates a transmit LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4737  * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4738  * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4739  * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4740  *
4741  * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4742  *
4743  * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4744  */
4745 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4746 {
4747 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4748 	return __ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(hw);
4749 #else
4750 	return NULL;
4751 #endif
4752 }
4753 
4754 /**
4755  * ieee80211_get_rx_led_name - get name of RX LED
4756  *
4757  * mac80211 creates a receive LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4758  * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4759  * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4760  * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4761  *
4762  * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4763  *
4764  * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4765  */
4766 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4767 {
4768 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4769 	return __ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(hw);
4770 #else
4771 	return NULL;
4772 #endif
4773 }
4774 
4775 /**
4776  * ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name - get name of association LED
4777  *
4778  * mac80211 creates a association LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4779  * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4780  * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4781  * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4782  *
4783  * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4784  *
4785  * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4786  */
4787 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4788 {
4789 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4790 	return __ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(hw);
4791 #else
4792 	return NULL;
4793 #endif
4794 }
4795 
4796 /**
4797  * ieee80211_get_radio_led_name - get name of radio LED
4798  *
4799  * mac80211 creates a radio change LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4800  * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4801  * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4802  * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4803  *
4804  * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4805  *
4806  * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4807  */
4808 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4809 {
4810 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4811 	return __ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(hw);
4812 #else
4813 	return NULL;
4814 #endif
4815 }
4816 
4817 /**
4818  * ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger - create throughput LED trigger
4819  * @hw: the hardware to create the trigger for
4820  * @flags: trigger flags, see &enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags
4821  * @blink_table: the blink table -- needs to be ordered by throughput
4822  * @blink_table_len: size of the blink table
4823  *
4824  * Return: %NULL (in case of error, or if no LED triggers are
4825  * configured) or the name of the new trigger.
4826  *
4827  * Note: This function must be called before ieee80211_register_hw().
4828  */
4829 static inline const char *
4830 ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, unsigned int flags,
4831 				 const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table,
4832 				 unsigned int blink_table_len)
4833 {
4834 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4835 	return __ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(hw, flags, blink_table,
4836 						  blink_table_len);
4837 #else
4838 	return NULL;
4839 #endif
4840 }
4841 
4842 /**
4843  * ieee80211_unregister_hw - Unregister a hardware device
4844  *
4845  * This function instructs mac80211 to free allocated resources
4846  * and unregister netdevices from the networking subsystem.
4847  *
4848  * @hw: the hardware to unregister
4849  */
4850 void ieee80211_unregister_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4851 
4852 /**
4853  * ieee80211_free_hw - free hardware descriptor
4854  *
4855  * This function frees everything that was allocated, including the
4856  * private data for the driver. You must call ieee80211_unregister_hw()
4857  * before calling this function.
4858  *
4859  * @hw: the hardware to free
4860  */
4861 void ieee80211_free_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4862 
4863 /**
4864  * ieee80211_restart_hw - restart hardware completely
4865  *
4866  * Call this function when the hardware was restarted for some reason
4867  * (hardware error, ...) and the driver is unable to restore its state
4868  * by itself. mac80211 assumes that at this point the driver/hardware
4869  * is completely uninitialised and stopped, it starts the process by
4870  * calling the ->start() operation. The driver will need to reset all
4871  * internal state that it has prior to calling this function.
4872  *
4873  * @hw: the hardware to restart
4874  */
4875 void ieee80211_restart_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4876 
4877 /**
4878  * ieee80211_rx_list - receive frame and store processed skbs in a list
4879  *
4880  * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
4881  * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
4882  * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
4883  * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
4884  * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
4885  *
4886  * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
4887  * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
4888  * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
4889  * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
4890  * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4891  *
4892  * This function must be called with BHs disabled and RCU read lock
4893  *
4894  * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4895  * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL
4896  * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4897  * @list: the destination list
4898  */
4899 void ieee80211_rx_list(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4900 		       struct sk_buff *skb, struct list_head *list);
4901 
4902 /**
4903  * ieee80211_rx_napi - receive frame from NAPI context
4904  *
4905  * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
4906  * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
4907  * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
4908  * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
4909  * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
4910  *
4911  * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
4912  * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
4913  * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
4914  * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
4915  * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4916  *
4917  * This function must be called with BHs disabled.
4918  *
4919  * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4920  * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL
4921  * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4922  * @napi: the NAPI context
4923  */
4924 void ieee80211_rx_napi(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4925 		       struct sk_buff *skb, struct napi_struct *napi);
4926 
4927 /**
4928  * ieee80211_rx - receive frame
4929  *
4930  * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
4931  * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
4932  * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
4933  * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
4934  * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
4935  *
4936  * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
4937  * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
4938  * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
4939  * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
4940  * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4941  *
4942  * In process context use instead ieee80211_rx_ni().
4943  *
4944  * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4945  * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4946  */
4947 static inline void ieee80211_rx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb)
4948 {
4949 	ieee80211_rx_napi(hw, NULL, skb, NULL);
4950 }
4951 
4952 /**
4953  * ieee80211_rx_irqsafe - receive frame
4954  *
4955  * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in IRQ context
4956  * (internally defers to a tasklet.)
4957  *
4958  * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni() may not
4959  * be mixed for a single hardware.Must not run concurrently with
4960  * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4961  *
4962  * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4963  * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4964  */
4965 void ieee80211_rx_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb);
4966 
4967 /**
4968  * ieee80211_rx_ni - receive frame (in process context)
4969  *
4970  * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in process context
4971  * (internally disables bottom halves).
4972  *
4973  * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may
4974  * not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
4975  * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4976  *
4977  * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4978  * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4979  */
4980 static inline void ieee80211_rx_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4981 				   struct sk_buff *skb)
4982 {
4983 	local_bh_disable();
4984 	ieee80211_rx(hw, skb);
4985 	local_bh_enable();
4986 }
4987 
4988 /**
4989  * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition - PS transition for connected sta
4990  *
4991  * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS
4992  * flag set, use this function to inform mac80211 about a connected station
4993  * entering/leaving PS mode.
4994  *
4995  * This function may not be called in IRQ context or with softirqs enabled.
4996  *
4997  * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized against
4998  * each other.
4999  *
5000  * @sta: currently connected sta
5001  * @start: start or stop PS
5002  *
5003  * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL when the requested PS mode is already set.
5004  */
5005 int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool start);
5006 
5007 /**
5008  * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni - PS transition for connected sta
5009  *                                  (in process context)
5010  *
5011  * Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() but can be called in process context
5012  * (internally disables bottom halves). Concurrent call restriction still
5013  * applies.
5014  *
5015  * @sta: currently connected sta
5016  * @start: start or stop PS
5017  *
5018  * Return: Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition().
5019  */
5020 static inline int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5021 						  bool start)
5022 {
5023 	int ret;
5024 
5025 	local_bh_disable();
5026 	ret = ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(sta, start);
5027 	local_bh_enable();
5028 
5029 	return ret;
5030 }
5031 
5032 /**
5033  * ieee80211_sta_pspoll - PS-Poll frame received
5034  * @sta: currently connected station
5035  *
5036  * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set,
5037  * use this function to inform mac80211 that a PS-Poll frame from a
5038  * connected station was received.
5039  * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition()
5040  * and possibly ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(); calls to all three must
5041  * be serialized.
5042  */
5043 void ieee80211_sta_pspoll(struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
5044 
5045 /**
5046  * ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger - (potential) U-APSD trigger frame received
5047  * @sta: currently connected station
5048  * @tid: TID of the received (potential) trigger frame
5049  *
5050  * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set,
5051  * use this function to inform mac80211 that a (potential) trigger frame
5052  * from a connected station was received.
5053  * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition()
5054  * and possibly ieee80211_sta_pspoll(); calls to all three must be
5055  * serialized.
5056  * %IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS can be passed as the tid if the tid is unknown.
5057  * In this case, mac80211 will not check that this tid maps to an AC
5058  * that is trigger enabled and assume that the caller did the proper
5059  * checks.
5060  */
5061 void ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
5062 
5063 /*
5064  * The TX headroom reserved by mac80211 for its own tx_status functions.
5065  * This is enough for the radiotap header.
5066  */
5067 #define IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_HEADROOM	ALIGN(14, 4)
5068 
5069 /**
5070  * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered - inform mac80211 about driver-buffered frames
5071  * @sta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer for the sleeping station
5072  * @tid: the TID that has buffered frames
5073  * @buffered: indicates whether or not frames are buffered for this TID
5074  *
5075  * If a driver buffers frames for a powersave station instead of passing
5076  * them back to mac80211 for retransmission, the station may still need
5077  * to be told that there are buffered frames via the TIM bit.
5078  *
5079  * This function informs mac80211 whether or not there are frames that are
5080  * buffered in the driver for a given TID; mac80211 can then use this data
5081  * to set the TIM bit (NOTE: This may call back into the driver's set_tim
5082  * call! Beware of the locking!)
5083  *
5084  * If all frames are released to the station (due to PS-poll or uAPSD)
5085  * then the driver needs to inform mac80211 that there no longer are
5086  * frames buffered. However, when the station wakes up mac80211 assumes
5087  * that all buffered frames will be transmitted and clears this data,
5088  * drivers need to make sure they inform mac80211 about all buffered
5089  * frames on the sleep transition (sta_notify() with %STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP).
5090  *
5091  * Note that technically mac80211 only needs to know this per AC, not per
5092  * TID, but since driver buffering will inevitably happen per TID (since
5093  * it is related to aggregation) it is easier to make mac80211 map the
5094  * TID to the AC as required instead of keeping track in all drivers that
5095  * use this API.
5096  */
5097 void ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5098 				u8 tid, bool buffered);
5099 
5100 /**
5101  * ieee80211_get_tx_rates - get the selected transmit rates for a packet
5102  *
5103  * Call this function in a driver with per-packet rate selection support
5104  * to combine the rate info in the packet tx info with the most recent
5105  * rate selection table for the station entry.
5106  *
5107  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5108  * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent.
5109  * @skb: the frame to be transmitted.
5110  * @dest: buffer for extracted rate/retry information
5111  * @max_rates: maximum number of rates to fetch
5112  */
5113 void ieee80211_get_tx_rates(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5114 			    struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5115 			    struct sk_buff *skb,
5116 			    struct ieee80211_tx_rate *dest,
5117 			    int max_rates);
5118 
5119 /**
5120  * ieee80211_sta_set_expected_throughput - set the expected tpt for a station
5121  *
5122  * Call this function to notify mac80211 about a change in expected throughput
5123  * to a station. A driver for a device that does rate control in firmware can
5124  * call this function when the expected throughput estimate towards a station
5125  * changes. The information is used to tune the CoDel AQM applied to traffic
5126  * going towards that station (which can otherwise be too aggressive and cause
5127  * slow stations to starve).
5128  *
5129  * @pubsta: the station to set throughput for.
5130  * @thr: the current expected throughput in kbps.
5131  */
5132 void ieee80211_sta_set_expected_throughput(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
5133 					   u32 thr);
5134 
5135 /**
5136  * ieee80211_tx_rate_update - transmit rate update callback
5137  *
5138  * Drivers should call this functions with a non-NULL pub sta
5139  * This function can be used in drivers that does not have provision
5140  * in updating the tx rate in data path.
5141  *
5142  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5143  * @pubsta: the station to update the tx rate for.
5144  * @info: tx status information
5145  */
5146 void ieee80211_tx_rate_update(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5147 			      struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
5148 			      struct ieee80211_tx_info *info);
5149 
5150 /**
5151  * ieee80211_tx_status - transmit status callback
5152  *
5153  * Call this function for all transmitted frames after they have been
5154  * transmitted. It is permissible to not call this function for
5155  * multicast frames but this can affect statistics.
5156  *
5157  * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
5158  * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls
5159  * to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni() and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe()
5160  * may not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5161  * ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni().
5162  *
5163  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5164  * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5165  */
5166 void ieee80211_tx_status(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5167 			 struct sk_buff *skb);
5168 
5169 /**
5170  * ieee80211_tx_status_ext - extended transmit status callback
5171  *
5172  * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status
5173  * in drivers that may want to provide extra information that does not
5174  * fit into &struct ieee80211_tx_info.
5175  *
5176  * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized
5177  * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni()
5178  * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5179  *
5180  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5181  * @status: tx status information
5182  */
5183 void ieee80211_tx_status_ext(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5184 			     struct ieee80211_tx_status *status);
5185 
5186 /**
5187  * ieee80211_tx_status_noskb - transmit status callback without skb
5188  *
5189  * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status
5190  * in drivers that cannot reliably map tx status information back to
5191  * specific skbs.
5192  *
5193  * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized
5194  * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni()
5195  * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5196  *
5197  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5198  * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent
5199  *	(NULL for multicast packets)
5200  * @info: tx status information
5201  */
5202 static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_noskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5203 					     struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5204 					     struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
5205 {
5206 	struct ieee80211_tx_status status = {
5207 		.sta = sta,
5208 		.info = info,
5209 	};
5210 
5211 	ieee80211_tx_status_ext(hw, &status);
5212 }
5213 
5214 /**
5215  * ieee80211_tx_status_ni - transmit status callback (in process context)
5216  *
5217  * Like ieee80211_tx_status() but can be called in process context.
5218  *
5219  * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status() and
5220  * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed
5221  * for a single hardware.
5222  *
5223  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5224  * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5225  */
5226 static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5227 					  struct sk_buff *skb)
5228 {
5229 	local_bh_disable();
5230 	ieee80211_tx_status(hw, skb);
5231 	local_bh_enable();
5232 }
5233 
5234 /**
5235  * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe - IRQ-safe transmit status callback
5236  *
5237  * Like ieee80211_tx_status() but can be called in IRQ context
5238  * (internally defers to a tasklet.)
5239  *
5240  * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status() and
5241  * ieee80211_tx_status_ni() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5242  *
5243  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5244  * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5245  */
5246 void ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5247 				 struct sk_buff *skb);
5248 
5249 /**
5250  * ieee80211_report_low_ack - report non-responding station
5251  *
5252  * When operating in AP-mode, call this function to report a non-responding
5253  * connected STA.
5254  *
5255  * @sta: the non-responding connected sta
5256  * @num_packets: number of packets sent to @sta without a response
5257  */
5258 void ieee80211_report_low_ack(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u32 num_packets);
5259 
5260 #define IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM 2
5261 
5262 /**
5263  * struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets - mutable beacon offsets
5264  * @tim_offset: position of TIM element
5265  * @tim_length: size of TIM element
5266  * @cntdwn_counter_offs: array of IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM offsets
5267  *	to countdown counters.  This array can contain zero values which
5268  *	should be ignored.
5269  * @mbssid_off: position of the multiple bssid element
5270  */
5271 struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets {
5272 	u16 tim_offset;
5273 	u16 tim_length;
5274 
5275 	u16 cntdwn_counter_offs[IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM];
5276 	u16 mbssid_off;
5277 };
5278 
5279 /**
5280  * ieee80211_beacon_get_template - beacon template generation function
5281  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5282  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5283  * @offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
5284  *	receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
5285  * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA
5286  *	that is not associated with AP MLD).
5287  *
5288  * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to
5289  * obtain the beacon template.
5290  *
5291  * This function should be used if the beacon frames are generated by the
5292  * device, and then the driver must use the returned beacon as the template
5293  * The driver or the device are responsible to update the DTIM and, when
5294  * applicable, the CSA count.
5295  *
5296  * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
5297  *
5298  * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error.
5299  */
5300 struct sk_buff *
5301 ieee80211_beacon_get_template(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5302 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5303 			      struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets *offs,
5304 			      unsigned int link_id);
5305 
5306 /**
5307  * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_index - EMA beacon template generation
5308  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5309  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5310  * @offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
5311  *	receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
5312  * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP).
5313  * @ema_index: index of the beacon in the EMA set.
5314  *
5315  * This function follows the same rules as ieee80211_beacon_get_template()
5316  * but returns a beacon template which includes multiple BSSID element at the
5317  * requested index.
5318  *
5319  * Return: The beacon template. %NULL indicates the end of EMA templates.
5320  */
5321 struct sk_buff *
5322 ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_index(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5323 					struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5324 					struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets *offs,
5325 					unsigned int link_id, u8 ema_index);
5326 
5327 /**
5328  * struct ieee80211_ema_beacons - List of EMA beacons
5329  * @cnt: count of EMA beacons.
5330  *
5331  * @bcn: array of EMA beacons.
5332  * @bcn.skb: the skb containing this specific beacon
5333  * @bcn.offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
5334  *	receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
5335  */
5336 struct ieee80211_ema_beacons {
5337 	u8 cnt;
5338 	struct {
5339 		struct sk_buff *skb;
5340 		struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets offs;
5341 	} bcn[];
5342 };
5343 
5344 /**
5345  * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list - EMA beacon template generation
5346  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5347  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5348  * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP)
5349  *
5350  * This function follows the same rules as ieee80211_beacon_get_template()
5351  * but allocates and returns a pointer to list of all beacon templates required
5352  * to cover all profiles in the multiple BSSID set. Each template includes only
5353  * one multiple BSSID element.
5354  *
5355  * Driver must call ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list() to free the memory.
5356  *
5357  * Return: EMA beacon templates of type struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *.
5358  *	%NULL on error.
5359  */
5360 struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *
5361 ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5362 				       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5363 				       unsigned int link_id);
5364 
5365 /**
5366  * ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list - free an EMA beacon template list
5367  * @ema_beacons: list of EMA beacons of type &struct ieee80211_ema_beacons pointers.
5368  *
5369  * This function will free a list previously acquired by calling
5370  * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list()
5371  */
5372 void ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list(struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *ema_beacons);
5373 
5374 /**
5375  * ieee80211_beacon_get_tim - beacon generation function
5376  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5377  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5378  * @tim_offset: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE offset.
5379  *	Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes).
5380  * @tim_length: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE length,
5381  *	(including the ID and length bytes!).
5382  *	Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes).
5383  * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA
5384  *	that is not associated with AP MLD).
5385  *
5386  * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to
5387  * obtain the beacon frame.
5388  *
5389  * If the beacon frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5390  * hardware/firmware), the driver uses this function to get each beacon
5391  * frame from mac80211 -- it is responsible for calling this function exactly
5392  * once before the beacon is needed (e.g. based on hardware interrupt).
5393  *
5394  * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
5395  *
5396  * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error.
5397  */
5398 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5399 					 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5400 					 u16 *tim_offset, u16 *tim_length,
5401 					 unsigned int link_id);
5402 
5403 /**
5404  * ieee80211_beacon_get - beacon generation function
5405  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5406  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5407  * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA
5408  *	that is not associated with AP MLD).
5409  *
5410  * See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim().
5411  *
5412  * Return: See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim().
5413  */
5414 static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5415 						   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5416 						   unsigned int link_id)
5417 {
5418 	return ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(hw, vif, NULL, NULL, link_id);
5419 }
5420 
5421 /**
5422  * ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn - request mac80211 to decrement the beacon countdown
5423  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5424  *
5425  * The beacon counter should be updated after each beacon transmission.
5426  * This function is called implicitly when
5427  * ieee80211_beacon_get/ieee80211_beacon_get_tim are called, however if the
5428  * beacon frames are generated by the device, the driver should call this
5429  * function after each beacon transmission to sync mac80211's beacon countdown.
5430  *
5431  * Return: new countdown value
5432  */
5433 u8 ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5434 
5435 /**
5436  * ieee80211_beacon_set_cntdwn - request mac80211 to set beacon countdown
5437  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5438  * @counter: the new value for the counter
5439  *
5440  * The beacon countdown can be changed by the device, this API should be
5441  * used by the device driver to update csa counter in mac80211.
5442  *
5443  * It should never be used together with ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn(),
5444  * as it will cause a race condition around the counter value.
5445  */
5446 void ieee80211_beacon_set_cntdwn(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 counter);
5447 
5448 /**
5449  * ieee80211_csa_finish - notify mac80211 about channel switch
5450  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5451  *
5452  * After a channel switch announcement was scheduled and the counter in this
5453  * announcement hits 1, this function must be called by the driver to
5454  * notify mac80211 that the channel can be changed.
5455  */
5456 void ieee80211_csa_finish(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5457 
5458 /**
5459  * ieee80211_beacon_cntdwn_is_complete - find out if countdown reached 1
5460  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5461  *
5462  * This function returns whether the countdown reached zero.
5463  */
5464 bool ieee80211_beacon_cntdwn_is_complete(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5465 
5466 /**
5467  * ieee80211_color_change_finish - notify mac80211 about color change
5468  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5469  *
5470  * After a color change announcement was scheduled and the counter in this
5471  * announcement hits 1, this function must be called by the driver to
5472  * notify mac80211 that the color can be changed
5473  */
5474 void ieee80211_color_change_finish(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5475 
5476 /**
5477  * ieee80211_proberesp_get - retrieve a Probe Response template
5478  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5479  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5480  *
5481  * Creates a Probe Response template which can, for example, be uploaded to
5482  * hardware. The destination address should be set by the caller.
5483  *
5484  * Can only be called in AP mode.
5485  *
5486  * Return: The Probe Response template. %NULL on error.
5487  */
5488 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_proberesp_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5489 					struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5490 
5491 /**
5492  * ieee80211_pspoll_get - retrieve a PS Poll template
5493  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5494  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5495  *
5496  * Creates a PS Poll a template which can, for example, uploaded to
5497  * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct
5498  * AID, BSSID and MAC address is used.
5499  *
5500  * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the
5501  * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit.
5502  *
5503  * Return: The PS Poll template. %NULL on error.
5504  */
5505 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_pspoll_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5506 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5507 
5508 /**
5509  * ieee80211_nullfunc_get - retrieve a nullfunc template
5510  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5511  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5512  * @link_id: If the vif is an MLD, get a frame with the link addresses
5513  *	for the given link ID. For a link_id < 0 you get a frame with
5514  *	MLD addresses, however useful that might be.
5515  * @qos_ok: QoS NDP is acceptable to the caller, this should be set
5516  *	if at all possible
5517  *
5518  * Creates a Nullfunc template which can, for example, uploaded to
5519  * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct
5520  * BSSID and address is used.
5521  *
5522  * If @qos_ndp is set and the association is to an AP with QoS/WMM, the
5523  * returned packet will be QoS NDP.
5524  *
5525  * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the
5526  * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit as well as Duration and Sequence Control fields.
5527  *
5528  * Return: The nullfunc template. %NULL on error.
5529  */
5530 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_nullfunc_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5531 				       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5532 				       int link_id, bool qos_ok);
5533 
5534 /**
5535  * ieee80211_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template
5536  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5537  * @src_addr: source MAC address
5538  * @ssid: SSID buffer
5539  * @ssid_len: length of SSID
5540  * @tailroom: tailroom to reserve at end of SKB for IEs
5541  *
5542  * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to
5543  * hardware.
5544  *
5545  * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error.
5546  */
5547 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5548 				       const u8 *src_addr,
5549 				       const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len,
5550 				       size_t tailroom);
5551 
5552 /**
5553  * ieee80211_rts_get - RTS frame generation function
5554  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5555  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5556  * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS.
5557  * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets).
5558  * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5559  * @rts: The buffer where to store the RTS frame.
5560  *
5561  * If the RTS frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5562  * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5563  * the next RTS frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible
5564  * for calling this function before and RTS frame is needed.
5565  */
5566 void ieee80211_rts_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5567 		       const void *frame, size_t frame_len,
5568 		       const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl,
5569 		       struct ieee80211_rts *rts);
5570 
5571 /**
5572  * ieee80211_rts_duration - Get the duration field for an RTS frame
5573  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5574  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5575  * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS.
5576  * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5577  *
5578  * If the RTS is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide
5579  * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5580  * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder.
5581  *
5582  * Return: The duration.
5583  */
5584 __le16 ieee80211_rts_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5585 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif, size_t frame_len,
5586 			      const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl);
5587 
5588 /**
5589  * ieee80211_ctstoself_get - CTS-to-self frame generation function
5590  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5591  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5592  * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self.
5593  * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets).
5594  * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5595  * @cts: The buffer where to store the CTS-to-self frame.
5596  *
5597  * If the CTS-to-self frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5598  * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5599  * the next CTS-to-self frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible
5600  * for calling this function before and CTS-to-self frame is needed.
5601  */
5602 void ieee80211_ctstoself_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5603 			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5604 			     const void *frame, size_t frame_len,
5605 			     const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl,
5606 			     struct ieee80211_cts *cts);
5607 
5608 /**
5609  * ieee80211_ctstoself_duration - Get the duration field for a CTS-to-self frame
5610  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5611  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5612  * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self.
5613  * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5614  *
5615  * If the CTS-to-self is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide
5616  * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5617  * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder.
5618  *
5619  * Return: The duration.
5620  */
5621 __le16 ieee80211_ctstoself_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5622 				    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5623 				    size_t frame_len,
5624 				    const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl);
5625 
5626 /**
5627  * ieee80211_generic_frame_duration - Calculate the duration field for a frame
5628  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5629  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5630  * @band: the band to calculate the frame duration on
5631  * @frame_len: the length of the frame.
5632  * @rate: the rate at which the frame is going to be transmitted.
5633  *
5634  * Calculate the duration field of some generic frame, given its
5635  * length and transmission rate (in 100kbps).
5636  *
5637  * Return: The duration.
5638  */
5639 __le16 ieee80211_generic_frame_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5640 					struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5641 					enum nl80211_band band,
5642 					size_t frame_len,
5643 					struct ieee80211_rate *rate);
5644 
5645 /**
5646  * ieee80211_get_buffered_bc - accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames
5647  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5648  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5649  *
5650  * Function for accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames. If
5651  * hardware/firmware does not implement buffering of broadcast/multicast
5652  * frames when power saving is used, 802.11 code buffers them in the host
5653  * memory. The low-level driver uses this function to fetch next buffered
5654  * frame. In most cases, this is used when generating beacon frame.
5655  *
5656  * Return: A pointer to the next buffered skb or NULL if no more buffered
5657  * frames are available.
5658  *
5659  * Note: buffered frames are returned only after DTIM beacon frame was
5660  * generated with ieee80211_beacon_get() and the low-level driver must thus
5661  * call ieee80211_beacon_get() first. ieee80211_get_buffered_bc() returns
5662  * NULL if the previous generated beacon was not DTIM, so the low-level driver
5663  * does not need to check for DTIM beacons separately and should be able to
5664  * use common code for all beacons.
5665  */
5666 struct sk_buff *
5667 ieee80211_get_buffered_bc(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5668 
5669 /**
5670  * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv - get a TKIP phase 1 key for IV32
5671  *
5672  * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32.
5673  *
5674  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5675  * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for
5676  * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5677  */
5678 void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5679 			       u32 iv32, u16 *p1k);
5680 
5681 /**
5682  * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key
5683  *
5684  * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the IV32 taken
5685  * from the given packet.
5686  *
5687  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5688  * @skb: the packet to take the IV32 value from that will be encrypted
5689  *	with this P1K
5690  * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5691  */
5692 static inline void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5693 					  struct sk_buff *skb, u16 *p1k)
5694 {
5695 	struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (struct ieee80211_hdr *)skb->data;
5696 	const u8 *data = (u8 *)hdr + ieee80211_hdrlen(hdr->frame_control);
5697 	u32 iv32 = get_unaligned_le32(&data[4]);
5698 
5699 	ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(keyconf, iv32, p1k);
5700 }
5701 
5702 /**
5703  * ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key for RX
5704  *
5705  * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32
5706  * and transmitter address.
5707  *
5708  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5709  * @ta: TA that will be used with the key
5710  * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for
5711  * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5712  */
5713 void ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5714 			       const u8 *ta, u32 iv32, u16 *p1k);
5715 
5716 /**
5717  * ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k - get a TKIP phase 2 key
5718  *
5719  * This function computes the TKIP RC4 key for the IV values
5720  * in the packet.
5721  *
5722  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5723  * @skb: the packet to take the IV32/IV16 values from that will be
5724  *	encrypted with this key
5725  * @p2k: a buffer to which the key will be written, 16 bytes
5726  */
5727 void ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5728 			    struct sk_buff *skb, u8 *p2k);
5729 
5730 /**
5731  * ieee80211_tkip_add_iv - write TKIP IV and Ext. IV to pos
5732  *
5733  * @pos: start of crypto header
5734  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5735  * @pn: PN to add
5736  *
5737  * Returns: pointer to the octet following IVs (i.e. beginning of
5738  * the packet payload)
5739  *
5740  * This function writes the tkip IV value to pos (which should
5741  * point to the crypto header)
5742  */
5743 u8 *ieee80211_tkip_add_iv(u8 *pos, struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, u64 pn);
5744 
5745 /**
5746  * ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq - get key RX sequence counter
5747  *
5748  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5749  * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only);
5750  *	the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For
5751  *	CMAC, only TID 0 is valid.
5752  * @seq: buffer to receive the sequence data
5753  *
5754  * This function allows a driver to retrieve the current RX IV/PNs
5755  * for the given key. It must not be called if IV checking is done
5756  * by the device and not by mac80211.
5757  *
5758  * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing
5759  * can be done concurrently.
5760  */
5761 void ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5762 			      int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
5763 
5764 /**
5765  * ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq - set key RX sequence counter
5766  *
5767  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5768  * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only);
5769  *	the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For
5770  *	CMAC, only TID 0 is valid.
5771  * @seq: new sequence data
5772  *
5773  * This function allows a driver to set the current RX IV/PNs for the
5774  * given key. This is useful when resuming from WoWLAN sleep and GTK
5775  * rekey may have been done while suspended. It should not be called
5776  * if IV checking is done by the device and not by mac80211.
5777  *
5778  * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing
5779  * can be done concurrently.
5780  */
5781 void ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5782 			      int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
5783 
5784 /**
5785  * ieee80211_remove_key - remove the given key
5786  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5787  *
5788  * Remove the given key. If the key was uploaded to the hardware at the
5789  * time this function is called, it is not deleted in the hardware but
5790  * instead assumed to have been removed already.
5791  *
5792  * Note that due to locking considerations this function can (currently)
5793  * only be called during key iteration (ieee80211_iter_keys().)
5794  */
5795 void ieee80211_remove_key(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
5796 
5797 /**
5798  * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add - add a GTK key from rekeying during WoWLAN
5799  * @vif: the virtual interface to add the key on
5800  * @keyconf: new key data
5801  *
5802  * When GTK rekeying was done while the system was suspended, (a) new
5803  * key(s) will be available. These will be needed by mac80211 for proper
5804  * RX processing, so this function allows setting them.
5805  *
5806  * The function returns the newly allocated key structure, which will
5807  * have similar contents to the passed key configuration but point to
5808  * mac80211-owned memory. In case of errors, the function returns an
5809  * ERR_PTR(), use IS_ERR() etc.
5810  *
5811  * Note that this function assumes the key isn't added to hardware
5812  * acceleration, so no TX will be done with the key. Since it's a GTK
5813  * on managed (station) networks, this is true anyway. If the driver
5814  * calls this function from the resume callback and subsequently uses
5815  * the return code 1 to reconfigure the device, this key will be part
5816  * of the reconfiguration.
5817  *
5818  * Note that the driver should also call ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq()
5819  * for the new key for each TID to set up sequence counters properly.
5820  *
5821  * IMPORTANT: If this replaces a key that is present in the hardware,
5822  * then it will attempt to remove it during this call. In many cases
5823  * this isn't what you want, so call ieee80211_remove_key() first for
5824  * the key that's being replaced.
5825  */
5826 struct ieee80211_key_conf *
5827 ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5828 			struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
5829 
5830 /**
5831  * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify - notify userspace supplicant of rekeying
5832  * @vif: virtual interface the rekeying was done on
5833  * @bssid: The BSSID of the AP, for checking association
5834  * @replay_ctr: the new replay counter after GTK rekeying
5835  * @gfp: allocation flags
5836  */
5837 void ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *bssid,
5838 				const u8 *replay_ctr, gfp_t gfp);
5839 
5840 /**
5841  * ieee80211_key_mic_failure - increment MIC failure counter for the key
5842  *
5843  * Note: this is really only safe if no other RX function is called
5844  * at the same time.
5845  *
5846  * @keyconf: the key in question
5847  */
5848 void ieee80211_key_mic_failure(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
5849 
5850 /**
5851  * ieee80211_key_replay - increment replay counter for the key
5852  *
5853  * Note: this is really only safe if no other RX function is called
5854  * at the same time.
5855  *
5856  * @keyconf: the key in question
5857  */
5858 void ieee80211_key_replay(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
5859 
5860 /**
5861  * ieee80211_wake_queue - wake specific queue
5862  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5863  * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
5864  *
5865  * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_wake_queue.
5866  */
5867 void ieee80211_wake_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
5868 
5869 /**
5870  * ieee80211_stop_queue - stop specific queue
5871  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5872  * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
5873  *
5874  * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_stop_queue.
5875  */
5876 void ieee80211_stop_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
5877 
5878 /**
5879  * ieee80211_queue_stopped - test status of the queue
5880  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5881  * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
5882  *
5883  * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_queue_stopped.
5884  *
5885  * Return: %true if the queue is stopped. %false otherwise.
5886  */
5887 
5888 int ieee80211_queue_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
5889 
5890 /**
5891  * ieee80211_stop_queues - stop all queues
5892  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5893  *
5894  * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_tx_stop_all_queues.
5895  */
5896 void ieee80211_stop_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5897 
5898 /**
5899  * ieee80211_wake_queues - wake all queues
5900  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5901  *
5902  * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_tx_wake_all_queues.
5903  */
5904 void ieee80211_wake_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5905 
5906 /**
5907  * ieee80211_scan_completed - completed hardware scan
5908  *
5909  * When hardware scan offload is used (i.e. the hw_scan() callback is
5910  * assigned) this function needs to be called by the driver to notify
5911  * mac80211 that the scan finished. This function can be called from
5912  * any context, including hardirq context.
5913  *
5914  * @hw: the hardware that finished the scan
5915  * @info: information about the completed scan
5916  */
5917 void ieee80211_scan_completed(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5918 			      struct cfg80211_scan_info *info);
5919 
5920 /**
5921  * ieee80211_sched_scan_results - got results from scheduled scan
5922  *
5923  * When a scheduled scan is running, this function needs to be called by the
5924  * driver whenever there are new scan results available.
5925  *
5926  * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans
5927  */
5928 void ieee80211_sched_scan_results(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5929 
5930 /**
5931  * ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped - inform that the scheduled scan has stopped
5932  *
5933  * When a scheduled scan is running, this function can be called by
5934  * the driver if it needs to stop the scan to perform another task.
5935  * Usual scenarios are drivers that cannot continue the scheduled scan
5936  * while associating, for instance.
5937  *
5938  * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans
5939  */
5940 void ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5941 
5942 /**
5943  * enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags - interface iteration flags
5944  * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL: Iterate over all interfaces that have
5945  *	been added to the driver; However, note that during hardware
5946  *	reconfiguration (after restart_hw) it will iterate over a new
5947  *	interface and over all the existing interfaces even if they
5948  *	haven't been re-added to the driver yet.
5949  * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL: During resume, iterate over all
5950  *	interfaces, even if they haven't been re-added to the driver yet.
5951  * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE: Iterate only active interfaces (netdev is up).
5952  * @IEEE80211_IFACE_SKIP_SDATA_NOT_IN_DRIVER: Skip any interfaces where SDATA
5953  *	is not in the driver.  This may fix crashes during firmware recovery
5954  *	for instance.
5955  */
5956 enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags {
5957 	IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL	= 0,
5958 	IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL	= BIT(0),
5959 	IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE	= BIT(1),
5960 	IEEE80211_IFACE_SKIP_SDATA_NOT_IN_DRIVER	= BIT(2),
5961 };
5962 
5963 /**
5964  * ieee80211_iterate_interfaces - iterate interfaces
5965  *
5966  * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
5967  * hardware and calls the callback for them. This includes active as well as
5968  * inactive interfaces. This function allows the iterator function to sleep.
5969  * Will iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
5970  *
5971  * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
5972  * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
5973  * @iterator: the iterator function to call
5974  * @data: first argument of the iterator function
5975  */
5976 void ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags,
5977 				  void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac,
5978 						   struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
5979 				  void *data);
5980 
5981 /**
5982  * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces - iterate active interfaces
5983  *
5984  * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
5985  * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
5986  * This function allows the iterator function to sleep, when the iterator
5987  * function is atomic @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic can
5988  * be used.
5989  * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
5990  *
5991  * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
5992  * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
5993  * @iterator: the iterator function to call
5994  * @data: first argument of the iterator function
5995  */
5996 static inline void
5997 ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags,
5998 				    void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac,
5999 						     struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6000 				    void *data)
6001 {
6002 	ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(hw,
6003 				     iter_flags | IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE,
6004 				     iterator, data);
6005 }
6006 
6007 /**
6008  * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic - iterate active interfaces
6009  *
6010  * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
6011  * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
6012  * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic,
6013  * if that is not desired, use @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces instead.
6014  * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
6015  *
6016  * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6017  * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6018  * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
6019  * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6020  */
6021 void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6022 						u32 iter_flags,
6023 						void (*iterator)(void *data,
6024 						    u8 *mac,
6025 						    struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6026 						void *data);
6027 
6028 /**
6029  * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_mtx - iterate active interfaces
6030  *
6031  * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
6032  * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
6033  * This version can only be used while holding the wiphy mutex.
6034  *
6035  * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6036  * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6037  * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
6038  * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6039  */
6040 void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_mtx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6041 					     u32 iter_flags,
6042 					     void (*iterator)(void *data,
6043 						u8 *mac,
6044 						struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6045 					     void *data);
6046 
6047 /**
6048  * ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic - iterate stations
6049  *
6050  * This function iterates over all stations associated with a given
6051  * hardware that are currently uploaded to the driver and calls the callback
6052  * function for them.
6053  * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic,
6054  *
6055  * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6056  * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
6057  * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6058  */
6059 void ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6060 				       void (*iterator)(void *data,
6061 						struct ieee80211_sta *sta),
6062 				       void *data);
6063 /**
6064  * ieee80211_queue_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue
6065  *
6066  * Drivers and mac80211 use this to add work onto the mac80211 workqueue.
6067  * This helper ensures drivers are not queueing work when they should not be.
6068  *
6069  * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for
6070  * @work: the work we want to add onto the mac80211 workqueue
6071  */
6072 void ieee80211_queue_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct work_struct *work);
6073 
6074 /**
6075  * ieee80211_queue_delayed_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue
6076  *
6077  * Drivers and mac80211 use this to queue delayed work onto the mac80211
6078  * workqueue.
6079  *
6080  * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for
6081  * @dwork: delayable work to queue onto the mac80211 workqueue
6082  * @delay: number of jiffies to wait before queueing
6083  */
6084 void ieee80211_queue_delayed_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6085 				  struct delayed_work *dwork,
6086 				  unsigned long delay);
6087 
6088 /**
6089  * ieee80211_refresh_tx_agg_session_timer - Refresh a tx agg session timer.
6090  * @sta: the station for which to start a BA session
6091  * @tid: the TID to BA on.
6092  *
6093  * This function allows low level driver to refresh tx agg session timer
6094  * to maintain BA session, the session level will still be managed by the
6095  * mac80211.
6096  *
6097  * Note: must be called in an RCU critical section.
6098  */
6099 void ieee80211_refresh_tx_agg_session_timer(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6100 					    u16 tid);
6101 
6102 /**
6103  * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session - Start a tx Block Ack session.
6104  * @sta: the station for which to start a BA session
6105  * @tid: the TID to BA on.
6106  * @timeout: session timeout value (in TUs)
6107  *
6108  * Return: success if addBA request was sent, failure otherwise
6109  *
6110  * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate
6111  * the need to start aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level
6112  * will be managed by the mac80211.
6113  */
6114 int ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid,
6115 				  u16 timeout);
6116 
6117 /**
6118  * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to aggregate.
6119  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6120  * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient.
6121  * @tid: the TID to BA on.
6122  *
6123  * This function must be called by low level driver once it has
6124  * finished with preparations for the BA session. It can be called
6125  * from any context.
6126  */
6127 void ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra,
6128 				      u16 tid);
6129 
6130 /**
6131  * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session - Stop a Block Ack session.
6132  * @sta: the station whose BA session to stop
6133  * @tid: the TID to stop BA.
6134  *
6135  * Return: negative error if the TID is invalid, or no aggregation active
6136  *
6137  * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate
6138  * the need to stop aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level
6139  * will be managed by the mac80211.
6140  */
6141 int ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid);
6142 
6143 /**
6144  * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to stop aggregate.
6145  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6146  * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient.
6147  * @tid: the desired TID to BA on.
6148  *
6149  * This function must be called by low level driver once it has
6150  * finished with preparations for the BA session tear down. It
6151  * can be called from any context.
6152  */
6153 void ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra,
6154 				     u16 tid);
6155 
6156 /**
6157  * ieee80211_find_sta - find a station
6158  *
6159  * @vif: virtual interface to look for station on
6160  * @addr: station's address
6161  *
6162  * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise.
6163  *
6164  * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the
6165  * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well.
6166  */
6167 struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6168 					 const u8 *addr);
6169 
6170 /**
6171  * ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr - find a station on hardware
6172  *
6173  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6174  * @addr: remote station's address
6175  * @localaddr: local address (vif->sdata->vif.addr). Use NULL for 'any'.
6176  *
6177  * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise.
6178  *
6179  * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the
6180  * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well.
6181  *
6182  * NOTE: You may pass NULL for localaddr, but then you will just get
6183  *      the first STA that matches the remote address 'addr'.
6184  *      We can have multiple STA associated with multiple
6185  *      logical stations (e.g. consider a station connecting to another
6186  *      BSSID on the same AP hardware without disconnecting first).
6187  *      In this case, the result of this method with localaddr NULL
6188  *      is not reliable.
6189  *
6190  * DO NOT USE THIS FUNCTION with localaddr NULL if at all possible.
6191  */
6192 struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6193 					       const u8 *addr,
6194 					       const u8 *localaddr);
6195 
6196 /**
6197  * ieee80211_find_sta_by_link_addrs - find STA by link addresses
6198  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6199  * @addr: remote station's link address
6200  * @localaddr: local link address, use %NULL for any (but avoid that)
6201  * @link_id: pointer to obtain the link ID if the STA is found,
6202  *	may be %NULL if the link ID is not needed
6203  *
6204  * Obtain the STA by link address, must use RCU protection.
6205  */
6206 struct ieee80211_sta *
6207 ieee80211_find_sta_by_link_addrs(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6208 				 const u8 *addr,
6209 				 const u8 *localaddr,
6210 				 unsigned int *link_id);
6211 
6212 /**
6213  * ieee80211_sta_block_awake - block station from waking up
6214  * @hw: the hardware
6215  * @pubsta: the station
6216  * @block: whether to block or unblock
6217  *
6218  * Some devices require that all frames that are on the queues
6219  * for a specific station that went to sleep are flushed before
6220  * a poll response or frames after the station woke up can be
6221  * delivered to that it. Note that such frames must be rejected
6222  * by the driver as filtered, with the appropriate status flag.
6223  *
6224  * This function allows implementing this mode in a race-free
6225  * manner.
6226  *
6227  * To do this, a driver must keep track of the number of frames
6228  * still enqueued for a specific station. If this number is not
6229  * zero when the station goes to sleep, the driver must call
6230  * this function to force mac80211 to consider the station to
6231  * be asleep regardless of the station's actual state. Once the
6232  * number of outstanding frames reaches zero, the driver must
6233  * call this function again to unblock the station. That will
6234  * cause mac80211 to be able to send ps-poll responses, and if
6235  * the station queried in the meantime then frames will also
6236  * be sent out as a result of this. Additionally, the driver
6237  * will be notified that the station woke up some time after
6238  * it is unblocked, regardless of whether the station actually
6239  * woke up while blocked or not.
6240  */
6241 void ieee80211_sta_block_awake(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6242 			       struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, bool block);
6243 
6244 /**
6245  * ieee80211_sta_eosp - notify mac80211 about end of SP
6246  * @pubsta: the station
6247  *
6248  * When a device transmits frames in a way that it can't tell
6249  * mac80211 in the TX status about the EOSP, it must clear the
6250  * %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP bit and call this function instead.
6251  * This applies for PS-Poll as well as uAPSD.
6252  *
6253  * Note that just like with _tx_status() and _rx() drivers must
6254  * not mix calls to irqsafe/non-irqsafe versions, this function
6255  * must not be mixed with those either. Use the all irqsafe, or
6256  * all non-irqsafe, don't mix!
6257  *
6258  * NB: the _irqsafe version of this function doesn't exist, no
6259  *     driver needs it right now. Don't call this function if
6260  *     you'd need the _irqsafe version, look at the git history
6261  *     and restore the _irqsafe version!
6262  */
6263 void ieee80211_sta_eosp(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
6264 
6265 /**
6266  * ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc - ask mac80211 to send NDP with EOSP
6267  * @pubsta: the station
6268  * @tid: the tid of the NDP
6269  *
6270  * Sometimes the device understands that it needs to close
6271  * the Service Period unexpectedly. This can happen when
6272  * sending frames that are filling holes in the BA window.
6273  * In this case, the device can ask mac80211 to send a
6274  * Nullfunc frame with EOSP set. When that happens, the
6275  * driver must have called ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() to
6276  * let mac80211 know that there are no buffered frames any
6277  * more, otherwise mac80211 will get the more_data bit wrong.
6278  * The low level driver must have made sure that the frame
6279  * will be sent despite the station being in power-save.
6280  * Mac80211 won't call allow_buffered_frames().
6281  * Note that calling this function, doesn't exempt the driver
6282  * from closing the EOSP properly, it will still have to call
6283  * ieee80211_sta_eosp when the NDP is sent.
6284  */
6285 void ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, int tid);
6286 
6287 /**
6288  * ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates - recalculate aggregate data after a change
6289  * @pubsta: the station
6290  *
6291  * Call this function after changing a per-link aggregate data as referenced in
6292  * &struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates by accessing the agg field of
6293  * &struct ieee80211_link_sta.
6294  *
6295  * With non MLO the data in deflink will be referenced directly. In that case
6296  * there is no need to call this function.
6297  */
6298 void ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
6299 
6300 /**
6301  * ieee80211_sta_register_airtime - register airtime usage for a sta/tid
6302  *
6303  * Register airtime usage for a given sta on a given tid. The driver must call
6304  * this function to notify mac80211 that a station used a certain amount of
6305  * airtime. This information will be used by the TXQ scheduler to schedule
6306  * stations in a way that ensures airtime fairness.
6307  *
6308  * The reported airtime should as a minimum include all time that is spent
6309  * transmitting to the remote station, including overhead and padding, but not
6310  * including time spent waiting for a TXOP. If the time is not reported by the
6311  * hardware it can in some cases be calculated from the rate and known frame
6312  * composition. When possible, the time should include any failed transmission
6313  * attempts.
6314  *
6315  * The driver can either call this function synchronously for every packet or
6316  * aggregate, or asynchronously as airtime usage information becomes available.
6317  * TX and RX airtime can be reported together, or separately by setting one of
6318  * them to 0.
6319  *
6320  * @pubsta: the station
6321  * @tid: the TID to register airtime for
6322  * @tx_airtime: airtime used during TX (in usec)
6323  * @rx_airtime: airtime used during RX (in usec)
6324  */
6325 void ieee80211_sta_register_airtime(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid,
6326 				    u32 tx_airtime, u32 rx_airtime);
6327 
6328 /**
6329  * ieee80211_txq_airtime_check - check if a txq can send frame to device
6330  *
6331  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6332  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
6333  *
6334  * Return true if the AQL's airtime limit has not been reached and the txq can
6335  * continue to send more packets to the device. Otherwise return false.
6336  */
6337 bool
6338 ieee80211_txq_airtime_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
6339 
6340 /**
6341  * ieee80211_iter_keys - iterate keys programmed into the device
6342  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6343  * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all
6344  * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key
6345  * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function
6346  *
6347  * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to
6348  * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into
6349  * the device. This is intended for use in WoWLAN if the device
6350  * needs reprogramming of the keys during suspend. Note that due
6351  * to locking reasons, it is also only safe to call this at few
6352  * spots since it must hold the RTNL and be able to sleep.
6353  *
6354  * The order in which the keys are iterated matches the order
6355  * in which they were originally installed and handed to the
6356  * set_key callback.
6357  */
6358 void ieee80211_iter_keys(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6359 			 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6360 			 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6361 				      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6362 				      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6363 				      struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
6364 				      void *data),
6365 			 void *iter_data);
6366 
6367 /**
6368  * ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu - iterate keys programmed into the device
6369  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6370  * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all
6371  * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key
6372  * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function
6373  *
6374  * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to
6375  * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into
6376  * the device. Note that due to locking reasons, keys of station
6377  * in removal process will be skipped.
6378  *
6379  * This function requires being called in an RCU critical section,
6380  * and thus iter must be atomic.
6381  */
6382 void ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6383 			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6384 			     void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6385 					  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6386 					  struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6387 					  struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
6388 					  void *data),
6389 			     void *iter_data);
6390 
6391 /**
6392  * ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic - iterate channel contexts
6393  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6394  * @iter: iterator function
6395  * @iter_data: data passed to iterator function
6396  *
6397  * Iterate all active channel contexts. This function is atomic and
6398  * doesn't acquire any locks internally that might be held in other
6399  * places while calling into the driver.
6400  *
6401  * The iterator will not find a context that's being added (during
6402  * the driver callback to add it) but will find it while it's being
6403  * removed.
6404  *
6405  * Note that during hardware restart, all contexts that existed
6406  * before the restart are considered already present so will be
6407  * found while iterating, whether they've been re-added already
6408  * or not.
6409  */
6410 void ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic(
6411 	struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6412 	void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6413 		     struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *chanctx_conf,
6414 		     void *data),
6415 	void *iter_data);
6416 
6417 /**
6418  * ieee80211_ap_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template
6419  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6420  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6421  *
6422  * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to
6423  * hardware. The template is filled with bssid, ssid and supported rate
6424  * information. This function must only be called from within the
6425  * .bss_info_changed callback function and only in managed mode. The function
6426  * is only useful when the interface is associated, otherwise it will return
6427  * %NULL.
6428  *
6429  * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error.
6430  */
6431 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_ap_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6432 					  struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6433 
6434 /**
6435  * ieee80211_beacon_loss - inform hardware does not receive beacons
6436  *
6437  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6438  *
6439  * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER and
6440  * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set, the driver needs to inform whenever the
6441  * hardware is not receiving beacons with this function.
6442  */
6443 void ieee80211_beacon_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6444 
6445 /**
6446  * ieee80211_connection_loss - inform hardware has lost connection to the AP
6447  *
6448  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6449  *
6450  * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER, and
6451  * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS and %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR are set, the driver
6452  * needs to inform if the connection to the AP has been lost.
6453  * The function may also be called if the connection needs to be terminated
6454  * for some other reason, even if %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR isn't set.
6455  *
6456  * This function will cause immediate change to disassociated state,
6457  * without connection recovery attempts.
6458  */
6459 void ieee80211_connection_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6460 
6461 /**
6462  * ieee80211_disconnect - request disconnection
6463  *
6464  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6465  * @reconnect: immediate reconnect is desired
6466  *
6467  * Request disconnection from the current network and, if enabled, send a
6468  * hint to the higher layers that immediate reconnect is desired.
6469  */
6470 void ieee80211_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool reconnect);
6471 
6472 /**
6473  * ieee80211_resume_disconnect - disconnect from AP after resume
6474  *
6475  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6476  *
6477  * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after resume.
6478  * Drivers can use this after WoWLAN if they know that the
6479  * connection cannot be kept up, for example because keys were
6480  * used while the device was asleep but the replay counters or
6481  * similar cannot be retrieved from the device during resume.
6482  *
6483  * Note that due to implementation issues, if the driver uses
6484  * the reconfiguration functionality during resume the interface
6485  * will still be added as associated first during resume and then
6486  * disconnect normally later.
6487  *
6488  * This function can only be called from the resume callback and
6489  * the driver must not be holding any of its own locks while it
6490  * calls this function, or at least not any locks it needs in the
6491  * key configuration paths (if it supports HW crypto).
6492  */
6493 void ieee80211_resume_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6494 
6495 /**
6496  * ieee80211_hw_restart_disconnect - disconnect from AP after
6497  * hardware restart
6498  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6499  *
6500  * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after
6501  * hardware restart.
6502  */
6503 void ieee80211_hw_restart_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6504 
6505 /**
6506  * ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify - inform a configured connection quality monitoring
6507  *	rssi threshold triggered
6508  *
6509  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6510  * @rssi_event: the RSSI trigger event type
6511  * @rssi_level: new RSSI level value or 0 if not available
6512  * @gfp: context flags
6513  *
6514  * When the %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI is set, and a connection quality
6515  * monitoring is configured with an rssi threshold, the driver will inform
6516  * whenever the rssi level reaches the threshold.
6517  */
6518 void ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6519 			       enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event rssi_event,
6520 			       s32 rssi_level,
6521 			       gfp_t gfp);
6522 
6523 /**
6524  * ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify - inform CQM of beacon loss
6525  *
6526  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6527  * @gfp: context flags
6528  */
6529 void ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, gfp_t gfp);
6530 
6531 /**
6532  * ieee80211_radar_detected - inform that a radar was detected
6533  *
6534  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6535  */
6536 void ieee80211_radar_detected(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6537 
6538 /**
6539  * ieee80211_chswitch_done - Complete channel switch process
6540  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6541  * @success: make the channel switch successful or not
6542  *
6543  * Complete the channel switch post-process: set the new operational channel
6544  * and wake up the suspended queues.
6545  */
6546 void ieee80211_chswitch_done(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool success);
6547 
6548 /**
6549  * ieee80211_channel_switch_disconnect - disconnect due to channel switch error
6550  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6551  * @block_tx: if %true, do not send deauth frame.
6552  *
6553  * Instruct mac80211 to disconnect due to a channel switch error. The channel
6554  * switch can request to block the tx and so, we need to make sure we do not send
6555  * a deauth frame in this case.
6556  */
6557 void ieee80211_channel_switch_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6558 					 bool block_tx);
6559 
6560 /**
6561  * ieee80211_request_smps - request SM PS transition
6562  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6563  * @link_id: link ID for MLO, or 0
6564  * @smps_mode: new SM PS mode
6565  *
6566  * This allows the driver to request an SM PS transition in managed
6567  * mode. This is useful when the driver has more information than
6568  * the stack about possible interference, for example by bluetooth.
6569  */
6570 void ieee80211_request_smps(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id,
6571 			    enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode);
6572 
6573 /**
6574  * ieee80211_ready_on_channel - notification of remain-on-channel start
6575  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6576  */
6577 void ieee80211_ready_on_channel(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6578 
6579 /**
6580  * ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired - remain_on_channel duration expired
6581  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6582  */
6583 void ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6584 
6585 /**
6586  * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session - callback to stop existing BA sessions
6587  *
6588  * in order not to harm the system performance and user experience, the device
6589  * may request not to allow any rx ba session and tear down existing rx ba
6590  * sessions based on system constraints such as periodic BT activity that needs
6591  * to limit wlan activity (eg.sco or a2dp)."
6592  * in such cases, the intention is to limit the duration of the rx ppdu and
6593  * therefore prevent the peer device to use a-mpdu aggregation.
6594  *
6595  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6596  * @ba_rx_bitmap: Bit map of open rx ba per tid
6597  * @addr: & to bssid mac address
6598  */
6599 void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 ba_rx_bitmap,
6600 				  const u8 *addr);
6601 
6602 /**
6603  * ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames - move RX BA window and mark filtered
6604  * @pubsta: station struct
6605  * @tid: the session's TID
6606  * @ssn: starting sequence number of the bitmap, all frames before this are
6607  *	assumed to be out of the window after the call
6608  * @filtered: bitmap of filtered frames, BIT(0) is the @ssn entry etc.
6609  * @received_mpdus: number of received mpdus in firmware
6610  *
6611  * This function moves the BA window and releases all frames before @ssn, and
6612  * marks frames marked in the bitmap as having been filtered. Afterwards, it
6613  * checks if any frames in the window starting from @ssn can now be released
6614  * (in case they were only waiting for frames that were filtered.)
6615  */
6616 void ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid,
6617 					  u16 ssn, u64 filtered,
6618 					  u16 received_mpdus);
6619 
6620 /**
6621  * ieee80211_send_bar - send a BlockAckReq frame
6622  *
6623  * can be used to flush pending frames from the peer's aggregation reorder
6624  * buffer.
6625  *
6626  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6627  * @ra: the peer's destination address
6628  * @tid: the TID of the aggregation session
6629  * @ssn: the new starting sequence number for the receiver
6630  */
6631 void ieee80211_send_bar(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 *ra, u16 tid, u16 ssn);
6632 
6633 /**
6634  * ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl - helper to queue an RX BA work
6635  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6636  * @addr: station mac address
6637  * @tid: the rx tid
6638  */
6639 void ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *addr,
6640 				 unsigned int tid);
6641 
6642 /**
6643  * ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl - start a Rx BA session
6644  *
6645  * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including
6646  * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx
6647  * reordering.
6648  *
6649  * Create structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here
6650  * when they complete AddBa negotiation.
6651  *
6652  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6653  * @addr: station mac address
6654  * @tid: the rx tid
6655  */
6656 static inline void ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6657 						      const u8 *addr, u16 tid)
6658 {
6659 	if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS))
6660 		return;
6661 	ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid);
6662 }
6663 
6664 /**
6665  * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl - stop a Rx BA session
6666  *
6667  * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including
6668  * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx
6669  * reordering.
6670  *
6671  * Destroy structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here
6672  * when they complete DelBa negotiation.
6673  *
6674  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6675  * @addr: station mac address
6676  * @tid: the rx tid
6677  */
6678 static inline void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6679 						     const u8 *addr, u16 tid)
6680 {
6681 	if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS))
6682 		return;
6683 	ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid + IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS);
6684 }
6685 
6686 /**
6687  * ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired - stop a Rx BA session due to timeout
6688  *
6689  * Some device drivers do not offload AddBa/DelBa negotiation, but handle rx
6690  * buffer reording internally, and therefore also handle the session timer.
6691  *
6692  * Trigger the timeout flow, which sends a DelBa.
6693  *
6694  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6695  * @addr: station mac address
6696  * @tid: the rx tid
6697  */
6698 void ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6699 				   const u8 *addr, unsigned int tid);
6700 
6701 /* Rate control API */
6702 
6703 /**
6704  * struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control - rate control information for/from RC algo
6705  *
6706  * @hw: The hardware the algorithm is invoked for.
6707  * @sband: The band this frame is being transmitted on.
6708  * @bss_conf: the current BSS configuration
6709  * @skb: the skb that will be transmitted, the control information in it needs
6710  *	to be filled in
6711  * @reported_rate: The rate control algorithm can fill this in to indicate
6712  *	which rate should be reported to userspace as the current rate and
6713  *	used for rate calculations in the mesh network.
6714  * @rts: whether RTS will be used for this frame because it is longer than the
6715  *	RTS threshold
6716  * @short_preamble: whether mac80211 will request short-preamble transmission
6717  *	if the selected rate supports it
6718  * @rate_idx_mask: user-requested (legacy) rate mask
6719  * @rate_idx_mcs_mask: user-requested MCS rate mask (NULL if not in use)
6720  * @bss: whether this frame is sent out in AP or IBSS mode
6721  */
6722 struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control {
6723 	struct ieee80211_hw *hw;
6724 	struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband;
6725 	struct ieee80211_bss_conf *bss_conf;
6726 	struct sk_buff *skb;
6727 	struct ieee80211_tx_rate reported_rate;
6728 	bool rts, short_preamble;
6729 	u32 rate_idx_mask;
6730 	u8 *rate_idx_mcs_mask;
6731 	bool bss;
6732 };
6733 
6734 /**
6735  * enum rate_control_capabilities - rate control capabilities
6736  */
6737 enum rate_control_capabilities {
6738 	/**
6739 	 * @RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW:
6740 	 * Support for extended NSS BW support (dot11VHTExtendedNSSCapable)
6741 	 * Note that this is only looked at if the minimum number of chains
6742 	 * that the AP uses is < the number of TX chains the hardware has,
6743 	 * otherwise the NSS difference doesn't bother us.
6744 	 */
6745 	RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW = BIT(0),
6746 	/**
6747 	 * @RATE_CTRL_CAPA_AMPDU_TRIGGER:
6748 	 * mac80211 should start A-MPDU sessions on tx
6749 	 */
6750 	RATE_CTRL_CAPA_AMPDU_TRIGGER = BIT(1),
6751 };
6752 
6753 struct rate_control_ops {
6754 	unsigned long capa;
6755 	const char *name;
6756 	void *(*alloc)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6757 	void (*add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, void *priv,
6758 			    struct dentry *debugfsdir);
6759 	void (*free)(void *priv);
6760 
6761 	void *(*alloc_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, gfp_t gfp);
6762 	void (*rate_init)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6763 			  struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
6764 			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta);
6765 	void (*rate_update)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6766 			    struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
6767 			    struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
6768 			    u32 changed);
6769 	void (*free_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6770 			 void *priv_sta);
6771 
6772 	void (*tx_status_ext)(void *priv,
6773 			      struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6774 			      void *priv_sta, struct ieee80211_tx_status *st);
6775 	void (*tx_status)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6776 			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
6777 			  struct sk_buff *skb);
6778 	void (*get_rate)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
6779 			 struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control *txrc);
6780 
6781 	void (*add_sta_debugfs)(void *priv, void *priv_sta,
6782 				struct dentry *dir);
6783 
6784 	u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(void *priv_sta);
6785 };
6786 
6787 static inline int rate_supported(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6788 				 enum nl80211_band band,
6789 				 int index)
6790 {
6791 	return (sta == NULL || sta->deflink.supp_rates[band] & BIT(index));
6792 }
6793 
6794 static inline s8
6795 rate_lowest_index(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6796 		  struct ieee80211_sta *sta)
6797 {
6798 	int i;
6799 
6800 	for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++)
6801 		if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i))
6802 			return i;
6803 
6804 	/* warn when we cannot find a rate. */
6805 	WARN_ON_ONCE(1);
6806 
6807 	/* and return 0 (the lowest index) */
6808 	return 0;
6809 }
6810 
6811 static inline
6812 bool rate_usable_index_exists(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6813 			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta)
6814 {
6815 	unsigned int i;
6816 
6817 	for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++)
6818 		if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i))
6819 			return true;
6820 	return false;
6821 }
6822 
6823 /**
6824  * rate_control_set_rates - pass the sta rate selection to mac80211/driver
6825  *
6826  * When not doing a rate control probe to test rates, rate control should pass
6827  * its rate selection to mac80211. If the driver supports receiving a station
6828  * rate table, it will use it to ensure that frames are always sent based on
6829  * the most recent rate control module decision.
6830  *
6831  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6832  * @pubsta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer to the target destination.
6833  * @rates: new tx rate set to be used for this station.
6834  */
6835 int rate_control_set_rates(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6836 			   struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
6837 			   struct ieee80211_sta_rates *rates);
6838 
6839 int ieee80211_rate_control_register(const struct rate_control_ops *ops);
6840 void ieee80211_rate_control_unregister(const struct rate_control_ops *ops);
6841 
6842 static inline bool
6843 conf_is_ht20(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6844 {
6845 	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20;
6846 }
6847 
6848 static inline bool
6849 conf_is_ht40_minus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6850 {
6851 	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 &&
6852 	       conf->chandef.center_freq1 < conf->chandef.chan->center_freq;
6853 }
6854 
6855 static inline bool
6856 conf_is_ht40_plus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6857 {
6858 	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 &&
6859 	       conf->chandef.center_freq1 > conf->chandef.chan->center_freq;
6860 }
6861 
6862 static inline bool
6863 conf_is_ht40(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6864 {
6865 	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40;
6866 }
6867 
6868 static inline bool
6869 conf_is_ht(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6870 {
6871 	return (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5) &&
6872 		(conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10) &&
6873 		(conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT);
6874 }
6875 
6876 static inline enum nl80211_iftype
6877 ieee80211_iftype_p2p(enum nl80211_iftype type, bool p2p)
6878 {
6879 	if (p2p) {
6880 		switch (type) {
6881 		case NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION:
6882 			return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT;
6883 		case NL80211_IFTYPE_AP:
6884 			return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO;
6885 		default:
6886 			break;
6887 		}
6888 	}
6889 	return type;
6890 }
6891 
6892 static inline enum nl80211_iftype
6893 ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
6894 {
6895 	return ieee80211_iftype_p2p(vif->type, vif->p2p);
6896 }
6897 
6898 /**
6899  * ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap_vif - return HE capabilities for sband/vif
6900  * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
6901  * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from
6902  *
6903  * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap, or %NULL is none found
6904  */
6905 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap *
6906 ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6907 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
6908 {
6909 	return ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif));
6910 }
6911 
6912 /**
6913  * ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa_vif - return HE 6 GHz capabilities
6914  * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on
6915  * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from
6916  *
6917  * Return: the 6GHz capabilities
6918  */
6919 static inline __le16
6920 ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6921 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
6922 {
6923 	return ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif));
6924 }
6925 
6926 /**
6927  * ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap_vif - return ETH capabilities for sband/vif
6928  * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
6929  * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from
6930  *
6931  * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap, or %NULL is none found
6932  */
6933 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap *
6934 ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6935 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
6936 {
6937 	return ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif));
6938 }
6939 
6940 /**
6941  * ieee80211_update_mu_groups - set the VHT MU-MIMO groud data
6942  *
6943  * @vif: the specified virtual interface
6944  * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, otherwise 0
6945  * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group
6946  * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group
6947  *
6948  * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid and the position and
6949  * membership data is of the correct size and are in the same byte order as the
6950  * matching GroupId management frame.
6951  * Calls to this function need to be serialized with RX path.
6952  */
6953 void ieee80211_update_mu_groups(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id,
6954 				const u8 *membership, const u8 *position);
6955 
6956 void ieee80211_enable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6957 				   int rssi_min_thold,
6958 				   int rssi_max_thold);
6959 
6960 void ieee80211_disable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6961 
6962 /**
6963  * ieee80211_ave_rssi - report the average RSSI for the specified interface
6964  *
6965  * @vif: the specified virtual interface
6966  *
6967  * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid.
6968  *
6969  * Return: The average RSSI value for the requested interface, or 0 if not
6970  * applicable.
6971  */
6972 int ieee80211_ave_rssi(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6973 
6974 /**
6975  * ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup - report WoWLAN wakeup
6976  * @vif: virtual interface
6977  * @wakeup: wakeup reason(s)
6978  * @gfp: allocation flags
6979  *
6980  * See cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup().
6981  */
6982 void ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6983 				    struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup *wakeup,
6984 				    gfp_t gfp);
6985 
6986 /**
6987  * ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb - prepare an 802.11 skb for transmission
6988  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6989  * @vif: virtual interface
6990  * @skb: frame to be sent from within the driver
6991  * @band: the band to transmit on
6992  * @sta: optional pointer to get the station to send the frame to
6993  *
6994  * Note: must be called under RCU lock
6995  */
6996 bool ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6997 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct sk_buff *skb,
6998 			      int band, struct ieee80211_sta **sta);
6999 
7000 /**
7001  * ieee80211_parse_tx_radiotap - Sanity-check and parse the radiotap header
7002  *				 of injected frames.
7003  *
7004  * To accurately parse and take into account rate and retransmission fields,
7005  * you must initialize the chandef field in the ieee80211_tx_info structure
7006  * of the skb before calling this function.
7007  *
7008  * @skb: packet injected by userspace
7009  * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device
7010  */
7011 bool ieee80211_parse_tx_radiotap(struct sk_buff *skb,
7012 				 struct net_device *dev);
7013 
7014 /**
7015  * struct ieee80211_noa_data - holds temporary data for tracking P2P NoA state
7016  *
7017  * @next_tsf: TSF timestamp of the next absent state change
7018  * @has_next_tsf: next absent state change event pending
7019  *
7020  * @absent: descriptor bitmask, set if GO is currently absent
7021  *
7022  * private:
7023  *
7024  * @count: count fields from the NoA descriptors
7025  * @desc: adjusted data from the NoA
7026  */
7027 struct ieee80211_noa_data {
7028 	u32 next_tsf;
7029 	bool has_next_tsf;
7030 
7031 	u8 absent;
7032 
7033 	u8 count[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX];
7034 	struct {
7035 		u32 start;
7036 		u32 duration;
7037 		u32 interval;
7038 	} desc[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX];
7039 };
7040 
7041 /**
7042  * ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa - initialize NoA tracking data from P2P IE
7043  *
7044  * @attr: P2P NoA IE
7045  * @data: NoA tracking data
7046  * @tsf: current TSF timestamp
7047  *
7048  * Return: number of successfully parsed descriptors
7049  */
7050 int ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa(const struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr *attr,
7051 			    struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf);
7052 
7053 /**
7054  * ieee80211_update_p2p_noa - get next pending P2P GO absent state change
7055  *
7056  * @data: NoA tracking data
7057  * @tsf: current TSF timestamp
7058  */
7059 void ieee80211_update_p2p_noa(struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf);
7060 
7061 /**
7062  * ieee80211_tdls_oper_request - request userspace to perform a TDLS operation
7063  * @vif: virtual interface
7064  * @peer: the peer's destination address
7065  * @oper: the requested TDLS operation
7066  * @reason_code: reason code for the operation, valid for TDLS teardown
7067  * @gfp: allocation flags
7068  *
7069  * See cfg80211_tdls_oper_request().
7070  */
7071 void ieee80211_tdls_oper_request(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *peer,
7072 				 enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper,
7073 				 u16 reason_code, gfp_t gfp);
7074 
7075 /**
7076  * ieee80211_reserve_tid - request to reserve a specific TID
7077  *
7078  * There is sometimes a need (such as in TDLS) for blocking the driver from
7079  * using a specific TID so that the FW can use it for certain operations such
7080  * as sending PTI requests. To make sure that the driver doesn't use that TID,
7081  * this function must be called as it flushes out packets on this TID and marks
7082  * it as blocked, so that any transmit for the station on this TID will be
7083  * redirected to the alternative TID in the same AC.
7084  *
7085  * Note that this function blocks and may call back into the driver, so it
7086  * should be called without driver locks held. Also note this function should
7087  * only be called from the driver's @sta_state callback.
7088  *
7089  * @sta: the station to reserve the TID for
7090  * @tid: the TID to reserve
7091  *
7092  * Returns: 0 on success, else on failure
7093  */
7094 int ieee80211_reserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
7095 
7096 /**
7097  * ieee80211_unreserve_tid - request to unreserve a specific TID
7098  *
7099  * Once there is no longer any need for reserving a certain TID, this function
7100  * should be called, and no longer will packets have their TID modified for
7101  * preventing use of this TID in the driver.
7102  *
7103  * Note that this function blocks and acquires a lock, so it should be called
7104  * without driver locks held. Also note this function should only be called
7105  * from the driver's @sta_state callback.
7106  *
7107  * @sta: the station
7108  * @tid: the TID to unreserve
7109  */
7110 void ieee80211_unreserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
7111 
7112 /**
7113  * ieee80211_tx_dequeue - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue
7114  *
7115  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7116  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface, or from
7117  *	ieee80211_next_txq()
7118  *
7119  * Returns the skb if successful, %NULL if no frame was available.
7120  *
7121  * Note that this must be called in an rcu_read_lock() critical section,
7122  * which can only be released after the SKB was handled. Some pointers in
7123  * skb->cb, e.g. the key pointer, are protected by RCU and thus the
7124  * critical section must persist not just for the duration of this call
7125  * but for the duration of the frame handling.
7126  * However, also note that while in the wake_tx_queue() method,
7127  * rcu_read_lock() is already held.
7128  *
7129  * softirqs must also be disabled when this function is called.
7130  * In process context, use ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni() instead.
7131  */
7132 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7133 				     struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
7134 
7135 /**
7136  * ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue
7137  * (in process context)
7138  *
7139  * Like ieee80211_tx_dequeue() but can be called in process context
7140  * (internally disables bottom halves).
7141  *
7142  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7143  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface, or from
7144  *	ieee80211_next_txq()
7145  */
7146 static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7147 						      struct ieee80211_txq *txq)
7148 {
7149 	struct sk_buff *skb;
7150 
7151 	local_bh_disable();
7152 	skb = ieee80211_tx_dequeue(hw, txq);
7153 	local_bh_enable();
7154 
7155 	return skb;
7156 }
7157 
7158 /**
7159  * ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue - mac80211 handler for wake_tx_queue callback
7160  *
7161  * @hw: pointer as obtained from wake_tx_queue() callback().
7162  * @txq: pointer as obtained from wake_tx_queue() callback().
7163  *
7164  * Drivers can use this function for the mandatory mac80211 wake_tx_queue
7165  * callback in struct ieee80211_ops. They should not call this function.
7166  */
7167 void ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7168 				    struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
7169 
7170 /**
7171  * ieee80211_next_txq - get next tx queue to pull packets from
7172  *
7173  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7174  * @ac: AC number to return packets from.
7175  *
7176  * Returns the next txq if successful, %NULL if no queue is eligible. If a txq
7177  * is returned, it should be returned with ieee80211_return_txq() after the
7178  * driver has finished scheduling it.
7179  */
7180 struct ieee80211_txq *ieee80211_next_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac);
7181 
7182 /**
7183  * ieee80211_txq_schedule_start - start new scheduling round for TXQs
7184  *
7185  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7186  * @ac: AC number to acquire locks for
7187  *
7188  * Should be called before ieee80211_next_txq() or ieee80211_return_txq().
7189  * The driver must not call multiple TXQ scheduling rounds concurrently.
7190  */
7191 void ieee80211_txq_schedule_start(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac);
7192 
7193 /* (deprecated) */
7194 static inline void ieee80211_txq_schedule_end(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac)
7195 {
7196 }
7197 
7198 void __ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7199 			      struct ieee80211_txq *txq, bool force);
7200 
7201 /**
7202  * ieee80211_schedule_txq - schedule a TXQ for transmission
7203  *
7204  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7205  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7206  *
7207  * Schedules a TXQ for transmission if it is not already scheduled,
7208  * even if mac80211 does not have any packets buffered.
7209  *
7210  * The driver may call this function if it has buffered packets for
7211  * this TXQ internally.
7212  */
7213 static inline void
7214 ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq)
7215 {
7216 	__ieee80211_schedule_txq(hw, txq, true);
7217 }
7218 
7219 /**
7220  * ieee80211_return_txq - return a TXQ previously acquired by ieee80211_next_txq()
7221  *
7222  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7223  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7224  * @force: schedule txq even if mac80211 does not have any buffered packets.
7225  *
7226  * The driver may set force=true if it has buffered packets for this TXQ
7227  * internally.
7228  */
7229 static inline void
7230 ieee80211_return_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq,
7231 		     bool force)
7232 {
7233 	__ieee80211_schedule_txq(hw, txq, force);
7234 }
7235 
7236 /**
7237  * ieee80211_txq_may_transmit - check whether TXQ is allowed to transmit
7238  *
7239  * This function is used to check whether given txq is allowed to transmit by
7240  * the airtime scheduler, and can be used by drivers to access the airtime
7241  * fairness accounting without going using the scheduling order enfored by
7242  * next_txq().
7243  *
7244  * Returns %true if the airtime scheduler thinks the TXQ should be allowed to
7245  * transmit, and %false if it should be throttled. This function can also have
7246  * the side effect of rotating the TXQ in the scheduler rotation, which will
7247  * eventually bring the deficit to positive and allow the station to transmit
7248  * again.
7249  *
7250  * The API ieee80211_txq_may_transmit() also ensures that TXQ list will be
7251  * aligned against driver's own round-robin scheduler list. i.e it rotates
7252  * the TXQ list till it makes the requested node becomes the first entry
7253  * in TXQ list. Thus both the TXQ list and driver's list are in sync. If this
7254  * function returns %true, the driver is expected to schedule packets
7255  * for transmission, and then return the TXQ through ieee80211_return_txq().
7256  *
7257  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7258  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7259  */
7260 bool ieee80211_txq_may_transmit(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7261 				struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
7262 
7263 /**
7264  * ieee80211_txq_get_depth - get pending frame/byte count of given txq
7265  *
7266  * The values are not guaranteed to be coherent with regard to each other, i.e.
7267  * txq state can change half-way of this function and the caller may end up
7268  * with "new" frame_cnt and "old" byte_cnt or vice-versa.
7269  *
7270  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7271  * @frame_cnt: pointer to store frame count
7272  * @byte_cnt: pointer to store byte count
7273  */
7274 void ieee80211_txq_get_depth(struct ieee80211_txq *txq,
7275 			     unsigned long *frame_cnt,
7276 			     unsigned long *byte_cnt);
7277 
7278 /**
7279  * ieee80211_nan_func_terminated - notify about NAN function termination.
7280  *
7281  * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function termination.
7282  * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq.
7283  *
7284  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7285  * @inst_id: the local instance id
7286  * @reason: termination reason (one of the NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_*)
7287  * @gfp: allocation flags
7288  */
7289 void ieee80211_nan_func_terminated(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7290 				   u8 inst_id,
7291 				   enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason reason,
7292 				   gfp_t gfp);
7293 
7294 /**
7295  * ieee80211_nan_func_match - notify about NAN function match event.
7296  *
7297  * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function match. The
7298  * cookie inside the match struct will be assigned by mac80211.
7299  * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq.
7300  *
7301  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7302  * @match: match event information
7303  * @gfp: allocation flags
7304  */
7305 void ieee80211_nan_func_match(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7306 			      struct cfg80211_nan_match_params *match,
7307 			      gfp_t gfp);
7308 
7309 /**
7310  * ieee80211_calc_rx_airtime - calculate estimated transmission airtime for RX.
7311  *
7312  * This function calculates the estimated airtime usage of a frame based on the
7313  * rate information in the RX status struct and the frame length.
7314  *
7315  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7316  * @status: &struct ieee80211_rx_status containing the transmission rate
7317  *          information.
7318  * @len: frame length in bytes
7319  */
7320 u32 ieee80211_calc_rx_airtime(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7321 			      struct ieee80211_rx_status *status,
7322 			      int len);
7323 
7324 /**
7325  * ieee80211_calc_tx_airtime - calculate estimated transmission airtime for TX.
7326  *
7327  * This function calculates the estimated airtime usage of a frame based on the
7328  * rate information in the TX info struct and the frame length.
7329  *
7330  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7331  * @info: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
7332  * @len: frame length in bytes
7333  */
7334 u32 ieee80211_calc_tx_airtime(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7335 			      struct ieee80211_tx_info *info,
7336 			      int len);
7337 /**
7338  * ieee80211_set_hw_80211_encap - enable hardware encapsulation offloading.
7339  *
7340  * This function is used to notify mac80211 that a vif can be passed raw 802.3
7341  * frames. The driver needs to then handle the 802.11 encapsulation inside the
7342  * hardware or firmware.
7343  *
7344  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7345  * @enable: indicate if the feature should be turned on or off
7346  */
7347 bool ieee80211_set_hw_80211_encap(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool enable);
7348 
7349 /**
7350  * ieee80211_get_fils_discovery_tmpl - Get FILS discovery template.
7351  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
7352  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7353  *
7354  * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
7355  *
7356  * Return: FILS discovery template. %NULL on error.
7357  */
7358 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_get_fils_discovery_tmpl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7359 						  struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7360 
7361 /**
7362  * ieee80211_get_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_tmpl - Get unsolicited broadcast
7363  *	probe response template.
7364  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
7365  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7366  *
7367  * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
7368  *
7369  * Return: Unsolicited broadcast probe response template. %NULL on error.
7370  */
7371 struct sk_buff *
7372 ieee80211_get_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_tmpl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7373 					  struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7374 
7375 /**
7376  * ieee80211_obss_color_collision_notify - notify userland about a BSS color
7377  * collision.
7378  *
7379  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7380  * @color_bitmap: a 64 bit bitmap representing the colors that the local BSS is
7381  *	aware of.
7382  * @gfp: allocation flags
7383  */
7384 void
7385 ieee80211_obss_color_collision_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7386 				      u64 color_bitmap, gfp_t gfp);
7387 
7388 /**
7389  * ieee80211_is_tx_data - check if frame is a data frame
7390  *
7391  * The function is used to check if a frame is a data frame. Frames with
7392  * hardware encapsulation enabled are data frames.
7393  *
7394  * @skb: the frame to be transmitted.
7395  */
7396 static inline bool ieee80211_is_tx_data(struct sk_buff *skb)
7397 {
7398 	struct ieee80211_tx_info *info = IEEE80211_SKB_CB(skb);
7399 	struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (void *) skb->data;
7400 
7401 	return info->flags & IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP ||
7402 	       ieee80211_is_data(hdr->frame_control);
7403 }
7404 
7405 /**
7406  * ieee80211_set_active_links - set active links in client mode
7407  * @vif: interface to set active links on
7408  * @active_links: the new active links bitmap
7409  *
7410  * This changes the active links on an interface. The interface
7411  * must be in client mode (in AP mode, all links are always active),
7412  * and @active_links must be a subset of the vif's valid_links.
7413  *
7414  * If a link is switched off and another is switched on at the same
7415  * time (e.g. active_links going from 0x1 to 0x10) then you will get
7416  * a sequence of calls like
7417  *  - change_vif_links(0x11)
7418  *  - unassign_vif_chanctx(link_id=0)
7419  *  - change_sta_links(0x11) for each affected STA (the AP)
7420  *    (TDLS connections on now inactive links should be torn down)
7421  *  - remove group keys on the old link (link_id 0)
7422  *  - add new group keys (GTK/IGTK/BIGTK) on the new link (link_id 4)
7423  *  - change_sta_links(0x10) for each affected STA (the AP)
7424  *  - assign_vif_chanctx(link_id=4)
7425  *  - change_vif_links(0x10)
7426  *
7427  * Note: This function acquires some mac80211 locks and must not
7428  *	 be called with any driver locks held that could cause a
7429  *	 lock dependency inversion. Best call it without locks.
7430  */
7431 int ieee80211_set_active_links(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 active_links);
7432 
7433 /**
7434  * ieee80211_set_active_links_async - asynchronously set active links
7435  * @vif: interface to set active links on
7436  * @active_links: the new active links bitmap
7437  *
7438  * See ieee80211_set_active_links() for more information, the only
7439  * difference here is that the link change is triggered async and
7440  * can be called in any context, but the link switch will only be
7441  * completed after it returns.
7442  */
7443 void ieee80211_set_active_links_async(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7444 				      u16 active_links);
7445 
7446 #endif /* MAC80211_H */
7447